blob: cd0eada904407e513952dfe2e38886de8d4f2add [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Chandler Carruthaa36b892015-12-30 03:40:23 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclContextInternals.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000024#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000025#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000027#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000028#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000029#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000031#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000032#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000033#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000034#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000035#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000036#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000038#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000039#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000040#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000041#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000042#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000043#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000044
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000045using namespace clang;
46
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000047unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
48unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000049unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
50unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000051unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
52unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000053unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
54unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000055unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
56unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000057unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
58unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
59
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000060enum FloatingRank {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +000061 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000062};
63
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000064RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000065 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
66 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +000067
68#ifndef NDEBUG
69 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
70 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
71 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
72#endif
73
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000074 CommentsLoaded = true;
75 }
76
77 assert(D);
78
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000079 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
80 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000081 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000082
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000083 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
84 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
85 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000086 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000087 }
88
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000089 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
90 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
91 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000092 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000093 }
94
95 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
96 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000097 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000098 }
99
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000100 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
101 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
102 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
103 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
104 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000105 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000106 }
107
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000108 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
109 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000110 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000111 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000112 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
113 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
114 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
115 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000116 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000117 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000118 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
119 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000120 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000121
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000122 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
123 // documentation.
124 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
125 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
126 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000127 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000128
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000129 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000130
131 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
132 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000133 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000134
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000135 // Find declaration location.
136 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
137 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
138 // location".
139 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
140 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
141 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
142 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000143 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000144 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
145 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000146 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000147 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000148 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000149 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
150 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
151 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
152 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
153 // the "declaration location".
154 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
155 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
156 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
157 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
158 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
159 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
160 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
161 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
162 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
163 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
164 }
165 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000166 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000167
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000168 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
169 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000170 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000171 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000172
173 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000174 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
175 {
176 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
177 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
178 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000179 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
180 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
181 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000182 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
183 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
184 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
185 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
186 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
187 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
188 }
189
190 if (Found) {
191 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
192 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
193 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
194 } else {
195 // Slow path.
196 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
197 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
198 }
199 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000200
201 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
202 // file buffer.
203 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
204
205 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
206 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000207 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000208 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000209 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000210 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000211 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000212 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
213 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
214 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
215 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
216 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
217 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000218 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000219 }
220 }
221
222 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
223 // Let's look at the previous comment.
224 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000225 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000226 --Comment;
227
228 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000229 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000230 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000231
232 // Decompose the end of the comment.
233 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000234 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000235
236 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
237 // aren't related.
238 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000239 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000240
241 // Get the corresponding buffer.
242 bool Invalid = false;
243 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
244 &Invalid).data();
245 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000246 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000247
248 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
249 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
250 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
251
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000252 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
253 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000254 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000255 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000256
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000257 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000258}
259
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000260namespace {
261/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
262/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000263/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000264const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000265 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000266 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000267 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000268 return FTD;
269
270 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
271 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
272 return D;
273
274 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
275 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
276 return FTD;
277
278 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
279 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
280 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
281 return MemberDecl;
282
283 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000284 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000285 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
286 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
287 // template?
288 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
289 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
290 return MemberDecl;
291
292 return D;
293 }
294 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
295 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
296 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
297 return CTD;
298
299 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
300 // specialization?
301 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
302 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
303 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
304 return D;
305 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
306 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
307 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
308 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
309 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
310 static_cast<const Decl*>(
311 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
312 }
313
314 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
315 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
316 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
317 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
318
319 return D;
320 }
321 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
322 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
323 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
324 return MemberDecl;
325
326 return D;
327 }
328 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000329 return D;
330}
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +0000331} // anonymous namespace
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000332
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000333const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
334 const Decl *D,
335 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000336 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000337
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000338 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
339 {
340 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
341 RedeclComments.find(D);
342 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
343 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000344 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
345 if (OriginalDecl)
346 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000347 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000348 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000349 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000350 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000351
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000352 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000353 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
354 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000355 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000356 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000357 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000358 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
359 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
360 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
361 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000362 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000363 break;
364 }
365 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000366 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
367 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000368 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
369 if (RC) {
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000370 // Call order swapped to work around ICE in VS2015 RTM (Release Win32)
371 // https://connect.microsoft.com/VisualStudio/feedback/details/1741530
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000372 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000373 Raw.setRaw(RC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000374 } else
375 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000376 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
377 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000378 if (RC)
379 break;
380 }
381 }
382
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000383 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
384 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000385
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000386 if (OriginalDecl)
387 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
388
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000389 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
390 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
391 Raw.setRaw(RC);
392 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000393 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000394
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000395 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
396 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000397 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
398 R = Raw;
399 }
400
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000401 return RC;
402}
403
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000404static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
405 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
406 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
407 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
408 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
409 if (!ID)
410 return;
411 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000412 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000413 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000414 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000415 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
416 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
417 }
418 }
419}
420
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000421comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
422 const Decl *D) const {
423 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
424 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
425 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
426 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
427 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000428 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
429 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000430 comments::FullComment *CFC =
431 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
432 ThisDeclInfo);
433 return CFC;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000434}
435
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000436comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
437 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000438 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000439}
440
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000441comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
442 const Decl *D,
443 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000444 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000445 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000446 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000447
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000448 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
449 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
450 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000451
452 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000453 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000454 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000455 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000456 return CFC;
457 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000458 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000459 }
460
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000461 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000462
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000463 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000464 if (!RC) {
465 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000466 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000467 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000468 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
469 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
470 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
471 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000472 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000473 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
474 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000475 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
476 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
477 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000478 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000479 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000480 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000481 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000482 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000483 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
484 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
485 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000486 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000487 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000488 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
489 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
490 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
491 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
492 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
493 }
494 }
495 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
496 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
497 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
498 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
499 }
500 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
501 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000502 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000503 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000504 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
505 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000506 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000507 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000508 if (Ty.isNull())
509 continue;
510 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
511 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
512 continue;
513
514 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
515 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
516 }
517 }
518 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000519 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
520 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000521 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000522 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000523 if (Ty.isNull())
524 continue;
525 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
526 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
527 continue;
528 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
529 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
530 }
531 }
532 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000533 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000534 }
535
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000536 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
537 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
538 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
539 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000540 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000541 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000542
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000543 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000544 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
545 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000546}
547
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000548void
549ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
550 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
551 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
552 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000553 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000554
555 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
556 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
557 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
558 PEnd = Params->end();
559 P != PEnd; ++P) {
560 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
561 ID.AddInteger(0);
562 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
563 continue;
564 }
565
566 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
567 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000568 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000569 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000570 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
571 ID.AddBoolean(true);
572 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000573 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
574 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
575 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
576 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000577 } else
578 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000579 continue;
580 }
581
582 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
583 ID.AddInteger(2);
584 Profile(ID, TTP);
585 }
586}
587
588TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
589ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000590 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000591 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
592 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
593 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000594 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000595 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
596 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
597 if (Canonical)
598 return Canonical->getParam();
599
600 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
601 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000602 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000603 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
604 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
605 PEnd = Params->end();
606 P != PEnd; ++P) {
607 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
608 CanonParams.push_back(
609 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000610 SourceLocation(),
611 SourceLocation(),
612 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000613 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000614 TTP->isParameterPack()));
615 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000616 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
617 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
618 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
619 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
620 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000621 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
622 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000623 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
624 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
625 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
626 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
627 }
628
629 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000630 SourceLocation(),
631 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000632 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000633 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000634 T,
635 TInfo,
636 ExpandedTypes.data(),
637 ExpandedTypes.size(),
638 ExpandedTInfos.data());
639 } else {
640 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000641 SourceLocation(),
642 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000643 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000644 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000645 T,
646 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
647 TInfo);
648 }
649 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
650
651 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000652 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
653 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
654 }
655
656 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
657 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
658 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000659 TTP->getPosition(),
660 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000661 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000662 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
663 SourceLocation(),
David Majnemer902f8c62015-12-27 07:16:27 +0000664 CanonParams,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000665 SourceLocation()));
666
667 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
668 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000669 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000670 (void)Canonical;
671
672 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
673 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
674 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
675 return CanonTTP;
676}
677
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000678CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000679 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000680
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000681 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000682 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000683 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000684 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +0000685 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000686 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +0000687 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000688 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +0000689 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000690 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000691 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000692 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
693 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000694 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000695}
696
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000697static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000698 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
699 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
700 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
701 // language-specific address space.
702 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
703 1, // opencl_global
704 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000705 3, // opencl_constant
Anastasia Stulova2c8dcfb2014-11-26 14:10:06 +0000706 4, // opencl_generic
707 5, // cuda_device
708 6, // cuda_constant
709 7 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000710 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000711 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000712 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000713 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000714 }
715}
716
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000717static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
718 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
719 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000720 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
721 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
722 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
723 return true;
724 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
725 return false;
726 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000727 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000728}
729
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000730ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000731 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000732 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000733 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
734 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
735 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
736 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr), Int128Decl(nullptr),
737 UInt128Decl(nullptr), Float128StubDecl(nullptr),
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +0000738 BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr), BuiltinMSVaListDecl(nullptr),
739 ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr), ObjCClassDecl(nullptr),
740 ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +0000741 CFConstantStringTagDecl(nullptr), CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr),
742 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr), FILEDecl(nullptr), jmp_bufDecl(nullptr),
743 sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr), ucontext_tDecl(nullptr),
744 BlockDescriptorType(nullptr), BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr),
745 cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr), FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
746 ExternCContext(nullptr), MakeIntegerSeqDecl(nullptr), SourceMgr(SM),
747 LangOpts(LOpts),
Alexey Samsonova511cdd2015-02-04 17:40:08 +0000748 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)),
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000749 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), AuxTarget(nullptr),
750 PrintingPolicy(LOpts), Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
751 BuiltinInfo(builtins), DeclarationNames(*this), ExternalSource(nullptr),
752 Listener(nullptr), Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000753 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000754 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
755}
756
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000757ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000758 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
759
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000760 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
761 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
762 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000763
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000764 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000765 for (auto &Pair : Deallocations)
766 (Pair.first)(Pair.second);
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000767
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000768 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000769 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
770 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
771 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
772 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
773 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
774 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
775 R->Destroy(*this);
776
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000777 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
778 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
779 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
780 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
781 R->Destroy(*this);
782 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000783
784 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
785 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
786 A != AEnd; ++A)
787 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000788
David Majnemere694f3e2015-08-14 14:43:50 +0000789 for (std::pair<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue *> &MTVPair :
790 MaterializedTemporaryValues)
791 MTVPair.second->~APValue();
792
Reid Kleckner588c9372014-02-19 23:44:52 +0000793 llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000794}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000795
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000796void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +0000797 if (!PointerParents) return;
798 for (const auto &Entry : *PointerParents) {
799 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
800 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
801 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
802 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
803 }
804 }
805 for (const auto &Entry : *OtherParents) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000806 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
807 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +0000808 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000809 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
810 }
811 }
812}
813
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000814void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000815 Deallocations.push_back({Callback, Data});
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000816}
817
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000818void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000819ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
820 ExternalSource = Source;
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000821}
822
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000823void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000824 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
825 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000826
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000827 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000828#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000829#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
830#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
831 0 // Extra
832 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000833
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000834 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
835 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000836 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000837 }
838
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000839 unsigned Idx = 0;
840 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
841#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
842 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000843 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
844 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000845 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
846 ++Idx;
847#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
848#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000849
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000850 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
851
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000852 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000853 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
854 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
855 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
856 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
857 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
858 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000859 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000860 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
861 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
862 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
863 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
864 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
865 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000866 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000867 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
868 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
869 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
870 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
871 << NumImplicitDestructors
872 << " implicit destructors created\n";
873
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000874 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000875 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000876 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
877 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000878
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000879 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000880}
881
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000882void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
883 bool NotifyListeners) {
884 if (NotifyListeners)
885 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
886 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
887
888 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
889 MergedDefModules[ND].push_back(M);
890 else
891 ND->setHidden(false);
892}
893
894void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
895 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(ND);
896 if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
897 return;
898
899 auto &Merged = It->second;
900 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
901 for (Module *&M : Merged)
902 if (!Found.insert(M).second)
903 M = nullptr;
904 Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end());
905}
906
Richard Smithf19e1272015-03-07 00:04:49 +0000907ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
908 if (!ExternCContext)
909 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
910
911 return ExternCContext;
912}
913
David Majnemerd9b1a4f2015-11-04 03:40:30 +0000914BuiltinTemplateDecl *
915ASTContext::buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BuiltinTemplateKind BTK,
916 const IdentifierInfo *II) const {
917 auto *BuiltinTemplate = BuiltinTemplateDecl::Create(*this, TUDecl, II, BTK);
918 BuiltinTemplate->setImplicit();
919 TUDecl->addDecl(BuiltinTemplate);
920
921 return BuiltinTemplate;
922}
923
924BuiltinTemplateDecl *
925ASTContext::getMakeIntegerSeqDecl() const {
926 if (!MakeIntegerSeqDecl)
927 MakeIntegerSeqDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__make_integer_seq,
928 getMakeIntegerSeqName());
929 return MakeIntegerSeqDecl;
930}
931
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000932RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
933 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000934 SourceLocation Loc;
935 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000936 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
937 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
938 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000939 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000940 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
941 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000942 NewDecl->setImplicit();
David Majnemerf8637362015-01-15 08:41:25 +0000943 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
944 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000945 return NewDecl;
946}
947
948TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
949 StringRef Name) const {
950 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
951 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
952 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
953 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
954 NewDecl->setImplicit();
955 return NewDecl;
956}
957
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000958TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000959 if (!Int128Decl)
960 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000961 return Int128Decl;
962}
963
964TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000965 if (!UInt128Decl)
966 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000967 return UInt128Decl;
968}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000969
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000970TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
Nico Weber5b0b46f2013-06-21 01:29:36 +0000971 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000972 if (!Float128StubDecl)
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000973 Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000974
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000975 return Float128StubDecl;
976}
977
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000978void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000979 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000980 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000981 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000982}
983
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000984void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target,
985 const TargetInfo *AuxTarget) {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000986 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
987 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000988 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000989
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000990 this->Target = &Target;
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000991 this->AuxTarget = AuxTarget;
992
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000993 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
994 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000995 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000996
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000997 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000998 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000999
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001000 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001001 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001002 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +00001003 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +00001004 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
1005 else
1006 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001007 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001008 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
1009 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
1010 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
1011 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
1012 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001013
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001014 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001015 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
1016 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
1017 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
1018 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
1019 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001020
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001021 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001022 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
1023 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
1024 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001025
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00001026 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
1027 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
1028 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
1029
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +00001030 // C++ 3.9.1p5
1031 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
1032 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1033 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1034 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1035 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1036 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1037 else {
1038 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1039 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1040 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001041
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +00001042 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1043
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001044 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1045 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
1046 else // C99
1047 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1048
1049 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1050 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
1051 else // C99
1052 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1053
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001054 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1055 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1056 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1057 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1058 // expressions.
1059 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001060
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00001061 // Placeholder type for functions.
1062 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1063
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001064 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1065 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1066
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001067 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1068 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1069
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001070 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1071 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1072
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001073 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1074 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1075
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001076 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1077 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1078
Alexey Bataev1a3320e2015-08-25 14:24:04 +00001079 // Placeholder type for OMP array sections.
1080 if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
1081 InitBuiltinType(OMPArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::OMPArraySection);
1082
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001083 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001084 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1085 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1086 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001087
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001088 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001089 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1090 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001091 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001092
1093 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1094 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1095 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1096 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1097 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1098 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001099 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dDepthTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dDepth);
1100 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayDepthTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayDepth);
1101 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dMSAATy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAA);
1102 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayMSAATy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAA);
1103 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dMSAADepthTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAADepth);
1104 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepthTy,
1105 BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepth);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001106 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001107
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001108 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001109 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001110 InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent);
1111 InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue);
1112 InitBuiltinType(OCLNDRangeTy, BuiltinType::OCLNDRange);
1113 InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001114 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001115
1116 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001117 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1118 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001119
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001120 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001121
1122 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001123
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001124 // void * type
1125 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001126
1127 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1128 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001129
1130 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1131 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001132
1133 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00001134 VaListTagDecl = nullptr;
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001135}
1136
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001137DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001138 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1139}
1140
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001141AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1142 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1143 if (!Result) {
1144 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1145 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1146 }
1147
1148 return *Result;
1149}
1150
1151/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1152void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1153 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1154 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1155 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1156 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1157 }
1158}
1159
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001160// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001161MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001162ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001163 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001164 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1165 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1166}
1167
1168ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1169ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1170 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1171 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1172 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1173 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001174
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001175 return Pos->second;
1176}
1177
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001178void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001179ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001180 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1181 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001182 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1183 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001184 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1185 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1186}
1187
1188void
1189ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1190 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1191 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1192 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1193 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001194}
1195
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001196FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1197 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1198 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1199 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001200 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1201 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001202 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001203
1204 return Pos->second;
1205}
1206
1207void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1208 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1209 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1210 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001211 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001212}
1213
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001214NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001215ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001216 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001217 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1218 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001219 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001220
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001221 return Pos->second;
1222}
1223
1224void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001225ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1226 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1227 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1228 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1229 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1230 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1231 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1232}
1233
1234UsingShadowDecl *
1235ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1236 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1237 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1238 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001239 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001240
1241 return Pos->second;
1242}
1243
1244void
1245ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1246 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1247 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1248 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001249}
1250
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001251FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1252 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1253 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1254 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001255 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001256
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001257 return Pos->second;
1258}
1259
1260void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1261 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1262 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1263 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1264 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1265 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001266
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001267 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1268}
1269
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001270ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1271ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1272 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001273 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001274 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001275 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001276
1277 return Pos->second.begin();
1278}
1279
1280ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1281ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1282 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001283 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001284 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001285 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001286
1287 return Pos->second.end();
1288}
1289
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001290unsigned
1291ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1292 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001293 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001294 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1295 return 0;
1296
1297 return Pos->second.size();
1298}
1299
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001300void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1301 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001302 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001303 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1304}
1305
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001306void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1307 const NamedDecl *D,
1308 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001309 assert(D);
1310
1311 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001312 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1313 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001314 return;
1315 }
1316
1317 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1318 if (!Method)
1319 return;
1320
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001321 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1322 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001323 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001324}
1325
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001326void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1327 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1328 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1329 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1330 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1331 LastLocalImport = Import;
1332 return;
1333 }
1334
1335 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1336 LastLocalImport = Import;
1337}
1338
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001339//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1340// Type Sizing and Analysis
1341//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001342
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001343/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1344/// scalar floating point type.
1345const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001346 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001347 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1348 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001349 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001350 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001351 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1352 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1353 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001354 }
1355}
1356
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001357CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001358 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001359
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001360 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1361 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1362 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001363
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001364 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1365 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1366 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1367 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001368 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001369 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1370 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1371 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1372 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1373 } else {
1374 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1375 }
1376 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001377 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1378 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1379 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1380 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001381
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001382 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1383 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001384 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001385 // do nothing
1386
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001387 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001388 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001389 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001390 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001391 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1392 else
1393 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1394 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001395 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1396 if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001397 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1398 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001399 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001400 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1401 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001402 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1403 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1404 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1405 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1406 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1407 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001408 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001409 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001410 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Ulrich Weigandb63f7792015-04-21 17:26:18 +00001411 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof)
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001412 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1413 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001414 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001415
1416 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1417 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1418 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1419 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1420 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001421 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1422 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1423 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1424 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1425 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001426
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001427 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1428 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001429
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001430 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1431 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1432 if (Offset > 0) {
1433 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1434 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1435 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1436 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1437 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1438 }
1439
1440 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001441 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001442 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001443 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001444
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001445 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001446}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001447
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001448// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1449// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1450// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1451// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1452std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1453ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1454 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1455
1456 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1457 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1458 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1459 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1460 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1461 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1462 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1463 }
1464 }
1465
1466 return sizeAndAlign;
1467}
1468
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001469/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1470/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1471std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1472static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1473 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1474 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1475 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1476 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001477 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1478 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001479 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1480 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1481 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001482 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1483 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001484 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001485 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1486 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1487}
1488
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001489std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001490ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001491 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1492 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001493 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1494 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1495 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001496}
1497
1498std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001499ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001500 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1501}
1502
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001503bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1504 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1505}
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001506
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001507bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1508 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1509}
1510
1511TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemerf8d38642014-07-30 08:42:33 +00001512 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1513 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1514 return I->second;
1515
1516 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1517 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1518 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
Rafael Espindolaeaa88c12014-07-30 04:40:23 +00001519 return TI;
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001520}
1521
1522/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1523/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001524///
1525/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1526/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1527/// should take a QualType, &c.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001528TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1529 uint64_t Width = 0;
1530 unsigned Align = 8;
1531 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001532 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001533#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1534#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001535#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001536#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001537#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1538 case Type::Class: \
1539 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1540 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001541#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001542 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001543
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001544 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1545 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001546 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1547 Width = 0;
1548 Align = 32;
1549 break;
1550
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001551 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001552 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001553 Width = 0;
1554 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1555 break;
1556
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001557 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001558 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001559
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001560 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001561 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001562 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001563 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001564 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1565 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001566 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1567 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001568 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001569 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001570 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001571 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001572 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001573 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001574 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1575 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001576 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001577 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1578 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001579 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001580 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001581 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001582 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001583 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1584 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1585 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1586 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001587 break;
1588 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001589
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001590 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001591 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001592 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001593 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001594 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1595 Width = 0;
1596 Align = 8;
1597 break;
1598
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001599 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001600 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1601 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001602 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001603 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1604 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1605 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001606 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001607 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1608 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001609 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001610 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1611 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001612 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1613 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001614 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001615 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001616 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1617 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001618 break;
1619 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001620 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1621 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001622 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001623 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001624 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001625 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1626 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001627 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001628 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001629 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001630 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1631 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001632 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001633 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001634 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001635 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1636 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001637 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001638 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001639 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001640 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1641 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001642 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001643 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1644 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1645 Width = 128;
1646 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1647 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001648 case BuiltinType::Half:
1649 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1650 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1651 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001652 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001653 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1654 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001655 break;
1656 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001657 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1658 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001659 break;
1660 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001661 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1662 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001663 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001664 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001665 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1666 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001667 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001668 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1669 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1670 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001671 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1672 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001673 break;
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001674 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1675 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1676 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1677 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1678 break;
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001679 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001680 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
1681 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
1682 case BuiltinType::OCLNDRange:
1683 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001684 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1685 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1686 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1687 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1688 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001689 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dDepth:
1690 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayDepth:
1691 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAA:
1692 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAA:
1693 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAADepth:
1694 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepth:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001695 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1696 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1697 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1698 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1699 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001700 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001701 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001702 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001703 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1704 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001705 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001706 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001707 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1708 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001709 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1710 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001711 break;
1712 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001713 case Type::LValueReference:
1714 case Type::RValueReference: {
1715 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1716 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001717 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1718 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001719 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1720 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001721 break;
1722 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001723 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001724 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001725 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1726 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001727 break;
1728 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001729 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001730 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Benjamin Kramer867ea1d2014-03-02 13:01:17 +00001731 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001732 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001733 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001734 case Type::Complex: {
1735 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1736 // size.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001737 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1738 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1739 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001740 break;
1741 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001742 case Type::ObjCObject:
1743 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001744 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001745 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001746 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001747 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001748 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001749 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001750 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001751 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001752 break;
1753 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001754 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001755 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001756 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1757
1758 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001759 Width = 8;
1760 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001761 break;
1762 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001763
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001764 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
1765 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
1766 TypeInfo Info =
1767 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
1768 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
1769 Info.Align = AttrAlign;
1770 Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
1771 }
1772 return Info;
1773 }
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001774
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001775 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001776 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1777 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001778 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001779 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001780 AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001781 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001782 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001783
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001784 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001785 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1786 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001787
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001788 case Type::Auto: {
1789 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001790 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1791 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001792 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001793 }
1794
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001795 case Type::Paren:
1796 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1797
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001798 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001799 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001800 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001801 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1802 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1803 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001804 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001805 Align = AttrAlign;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001806 AlignIsRequired = true;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001807 } else {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001808 Align = Info.Align;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001809 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1810 }
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001811 Width = Info.Width;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001812 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001813 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001814
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001815 case Type::Elaborated:
1816 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001817
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001818 case Type::Attributed:
1819 return getTypeInfo(
1820 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1821
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001822 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001823 // Start with the base type information.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001824 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1825 Width = Info.Width;
1826 Align = Info.Align;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001827
1828 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1829 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1830 // favorable to atomic operations:
1831 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1832 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1833 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1834 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1835
1836 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001837 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1838 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001839 }
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00001840 break;
1841
1842 case Type::Pipe: {
1843 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<PipeType>(T)->getElementType());
1844 Width = Info.Width;
1845 Align = Info.Align;
1846 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001847
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001848 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001849
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001850 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001851 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001852}
1853
Alexey Bataev00396512015-07-02 03:40:19 +00001854unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
1855 unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign();
1856 // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32.
1857 if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 ||
1858 getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) &&
1859 getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" &&
1860 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
1861 SimdAlign = 256;
1862 return SimdAlign;
1863}
1864
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001865/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1866CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1867 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1868}
1869
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001870/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1871int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1872 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1873}
1874
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001875/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1876/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001877CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001878 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001879}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001880CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001881 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001882}
1883
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001884/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001885/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001886CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001887 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001888}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001889CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001890 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001891}
1892
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001893/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1894/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1895/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1896/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001897unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001898 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
1899 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001900
David Majnemere1544562015-04-24 01:25:05 +00001901 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1902
1903 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
1904 if (T->isMemberPointerType())
1905 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
1906
Andrey Turetskiydb6655f2016-02-10 11:58:46 +00001907 if (!Target->allowsLargerPreferedTypeAlignment())
1908 return ABIAlign;
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00001909
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001910 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00001911 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001912 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001913 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
1914 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001915 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001916 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1917 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001918 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1919 // typedef declaration.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001920 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001921 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001922
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001923 return ABIAlign;
1924}
1925
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00001926/// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
1927/// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
1928/// value is specified.
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00001929unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned() const {
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00001930 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
1931}
1932
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001933/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1934/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1935unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1936 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1937}
1938
1939/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1940/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1941CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1942 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1943}
1944
David Majnemer08ef2ba2015-06-23 20:34:18 +00001945CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
1946 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
1947 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
1948 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
1949 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
1950 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
1951 }
1952 return Offset;
1953}
1954
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001955/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1956/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1957/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1958/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1959/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001960///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001961void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1962 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001963 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001964 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1965 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1966 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00001967 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
1968 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001969 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001970 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001971 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001972 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1973 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1974 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001975}
1976
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001977/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1978/// those inherited by it.
1979void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001980 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001981 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001982 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1983 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00001984 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00001985 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001986 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001987
1988 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00001989 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
1990 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001991
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001992 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1993 while (SD) {
1994 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1995 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1996 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001997 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00001998 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00001999 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002000 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002001 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002002 // Insert the protocol.
2003 if (!Protocols.insert(
2004 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second)
2005 return;
2006
2007 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols())
2008 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002009 }
2010}
2011
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002012unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002013 unsigned count = 0;
2014 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00002015 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002016 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002017
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002018 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
2019 // includes synthesized ivars.
2020 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002021 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
2022
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00002023 return count;
2024}
2025
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00002026bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
2027 if (!E)
2028 return false;
2029
2030 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
2031 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
2032
2033 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
2034 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
2035 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2036 return true;
2037
2038 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
2039 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
2040
2041 return false;
2042}
2043
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002044/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
2045ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
2046 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2047 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2048 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2049 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002050 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002051}
2052/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
2053ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
2054 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2055 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2056 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2057 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002058 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002059}
2060
2061/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
2062void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
2063 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
2064 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2065 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2066}
2067/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
2068void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2069 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2070 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2071 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2072}
2073
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00002074const ObjCMethodDecl *
2075ASTContext::getObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) const {
2076 return ObjCMethodRedecls.lookup(MD);
2077}
2078
2079void ASTContext::setObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD,
2080 const ObjCMethodDecl *Redecl) {
2081 assert(!getObjCMethodRedeclaration(MD) && "MD already has a redeclaration");
2082 ObjCMethodRedecls[MD] = Redecl;
2083}
2084
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002085const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2086 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2087 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
2088 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002089 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002090 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
2091 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002092 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002093 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
2094 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002095 return IMD->getClassInterface();
2096
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002097 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002098}
2099
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002100/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
2101/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002102Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002103 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2104 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2105 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002106 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002107 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002108 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002109}
2110
2111/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
2112void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
2113 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002114 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2115 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002116 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
2117}
2118
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002119TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002120 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002121 if (!DataSize)
2122 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2123 else
2124 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002125 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002126
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002127 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
2128 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2129 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2130 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00002131}
2132
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002133TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00002134 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002135 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00002136 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00002137 return DI;
2138}
2139
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002140const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002141ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002142 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002143}
2144
2145const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002146ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2147 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002148 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2149}
2150
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002151//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2152// Type creation/memoization methods
2153//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2154
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002155QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002156ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2157 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2158 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002159
2160 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2161 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002162 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002163 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002164 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2165 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2166 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002167 }
2168
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002169 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2170 QualType canon;
2171 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2172 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002173 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2174 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002175
2176 // Re-find the insert position.
2177 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2178 }
2179
2180 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2181 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2182 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002183}
2184
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002185QualType
2186ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002187 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2188 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002189 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002190
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002191 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2192 // into one ExtQuals node.
2193 QualifierCollector Quals;
2194 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002195
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002196 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2197 // another one.
2198 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2199 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2200 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002201
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002202 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002203}
2204
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002205QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002206 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002207 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002208 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002209 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002210
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002211 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2212 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002213 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002214 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2215 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2216 }
2217 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002218
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002219 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2220 // into one ExtQuals node.
2221 QualifierCollector Quals;
2222 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002223
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002224 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2225 // another one.
2226 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2227 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2228 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002229
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002230 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002231}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002232
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002233const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2234 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2235 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2236 return T;
2237
2238 QualType Result;
2239 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002240 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002241 } else {
2242 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2243 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2244 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002245 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002246 }
2247
2248 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2249}
2250
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002251void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2252 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002253 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2254 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002255 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2256 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002257 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002258 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2259 FD = Next;
2260 else
2261 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002262 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002263 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2264 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002265}
2266
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002267/// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2268/// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2269/// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2270/// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
2271static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2272 ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig,
2273 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
2274 // Might have some parens.
2275 if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
2276 return Context.getParenType(
2277 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
2278
2279 // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2280 if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
2281 return Context.getAttributedType(
2282 AT->getAttrKind(),
2283 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2284 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(),
2285 ESI));
2286
2287 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2288 // specification.
2289 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
2290 return Context.getFunctionType(
2291 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2292 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2293}
2294
2295void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2296 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2297 bool AsWritten) {
2298 // Update the type.
2299 QualType Updated =
2300 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI);
2301 FD->setType(Updated);
2302
2303 if (!AsWritten)
2304 return;
2305
2306 // Update the type in the type source information too.
2307 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2308 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2309 // the type-as-written too.
2310 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
2311 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
2312
2313 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2314 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2315 // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2316 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2317 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2318 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2319 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2320 }
2321}
2322
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002323/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2324/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002325QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002326 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2327 // structure.
2328 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2329 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002330
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002331 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002332 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2333 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002334
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002335 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2336 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2337 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002338 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002339 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002340
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002341 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2342 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002343 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002344 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002345 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002346 Types.push_back(New);
2347 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2348 return QualType(New, 0);
2349}
2350
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002351/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2352/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002353QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002354 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2355 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002356 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002357 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002358
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002359 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002360 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002361 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002362
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002363 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2364 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002365 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002366 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002367 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002368
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002369 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2370 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002371 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002372 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002373 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002374 Types.push_back(New);
2375 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002376 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002377}
2378
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002379QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2380 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2381 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002382 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002383 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2384 if (AT)
2385 return QualType(AT, 0);
2386
2387 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2388
2389 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2390 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002391 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002392
2393 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2394 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2395 Types.push_back(AT);
2396 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2397 return QualType(AT, 0);
2398}
2399
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002400QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2401 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2402
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002403 QualType Decayed;
2404
2405 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2406 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2407 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2408 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2409 // the array type derivation.
2410 if (T->isArrayType())
2411 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2412
2413 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2414 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2415 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2416 // in 6.3.2.1.
2417 if (T->isFunctionType())
2418 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2419
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002420 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2421 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002422 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002423 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2424 if (AT)
2425 return QualType(AT, 0);
2426
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002427 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2428
2429 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002430 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002431 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002432
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002433 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2434 Types.push_back(AT);
2435 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2436 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002437}
2438
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002439/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002440/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002441QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002442 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2443 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002444 // structure.
2445 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2446 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002447
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002448 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002449 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2450 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2451 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002452
2453 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002454 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2455 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002456 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002457 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002458
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002459 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2460 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2461 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002462 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002463 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002464 BlockPointerType *New
2465 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002466 Types.push_back(New);
2467 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2468 return QualType(New, 0);
2469}
2470
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002471/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2472/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002473QualType
2474ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002475 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2476 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2477
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002478 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2479 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002480 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002481 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002482
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002483 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002484 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2485 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002486 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002487
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002488 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2489
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002490 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2491 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2492 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002493 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2494 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2495 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002496
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002497 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002498 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2499 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002500 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002501 }
2502
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002503 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002504 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2505 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002506 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002507 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002508
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002509 return QualType(New, 0);
2510}
2511
2512/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2513/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002514QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002515 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2516 // structure.
2517 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002518 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002519
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002520 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002521 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2522 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2523 return QualType(RT, 0);
2524
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002525 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2526
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002527 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2528 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2529 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002530 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2531 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2532 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002533
2534 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2535 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2536 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002537 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002538 }
2539
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002540 RValueReferenceType *New
2541 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002542 Types.push_back(New);
2543 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002544 return QualType(New, 0);
2545}
2546
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002547/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2548/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002549QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002550 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2551 // structure.
2552 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2553 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2554
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002555 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002556 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2557 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2558 return QualType(PT, 0);
2559
2560 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2561 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2562 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002563 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002564 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2565
2566 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2567 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2568 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002569 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002570 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002571 MemberPointerType *New
2572 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002573 Types.push_back(New);
2574 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2575 return QualType(New, 0);
2576}
2577
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002578/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002579/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002580QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002581 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002582 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002583 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002584 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2585 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002586 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2587
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002588 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2589 // the target.
2590 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002591 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002592 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002593
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002594 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002595 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002596
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002597 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002598 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002599 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002600 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002601
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002602 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2603 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2604 QualType Canon;
2605 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2606 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002607 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002608 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002609 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002610
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002611 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002612 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002613 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002614 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002615 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002616
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002617 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002618 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002619 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002620 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002621 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002622}
2623
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002624/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2625/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2626/// sizes replaced with [*].
2627QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2628 // Vastly most common case.
2629 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002630
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002631 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002632
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002633 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002634 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002635 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2636#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2637#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2638#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2639#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2640 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2641
2642 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2643 case Type::Builtin:
2644 case Type::Complex:
2645 case Type::Vector:
2646 case Type::ExtVector:
2647 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2648 case Type::ObjCObject:
2649 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2650 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2651 case Type::Record:
2652 case Type::Enum:
2653 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2654 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2655 case Type::TypeOf:
2656 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002657 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002658 case Type::DependentName:
2659 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2660 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2661 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2662 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2663 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002664 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002665 case Type::PackExpansion:
2666 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2667
2668 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2669 // further decay.
2670 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2671 case Type::FunctionProto:
2672 case Type::BlockPointer:
2673 case Type::MemberPointer:
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00002674 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002675 return type;
2676
2677 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2678 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2679 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2680 // optimizations available here.
2681 case Type::Pointer:
2682 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2683 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2684 break;
2685
2686 case Type::LValueReference: {
2687 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2688 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2689 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2690 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2691 break;
2692 }
2693
2694 case Type::RValueReference: {
2695 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2696 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2697 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2698 break;
2699 }
2700
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002701 case Type::Atomic: {
2702 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2703 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2704 break;
2705 }
2706
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002707 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2708 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2709 result = getConstantArrayType(
2710 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2711 cat->getSize(),
2712 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2713 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2714 break;
2715 }
2716
2717 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2718 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2719 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2720 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2721 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2722 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2723 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2724 dat->getBracketsRange());
2725 break;
2726 }
2727
2728 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2729 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2730 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2731 result = getVariableArrayType(
2732 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002733 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002734 ArrayType::Normal,
2735 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2736 SourceRange());
2737 break;
2738 }
2739
2740 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2741 case Type::VariableArray: {
2742 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2743 result = getVariableArrayType(
2744 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002745 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002746 ArrayType::Star,
2747 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2748 vat->getBracketsRange());
2749 break;
2750 }
2751 }
2752
2753 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002754 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002755}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002756
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002757/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2758/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002759QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2760 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002761 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002762 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002763 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002764 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2765 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002766 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002767
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002768 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2769 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2770 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002771 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002772 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002773 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002774 }
2775
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002776 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002777 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002778
2779 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2780 Types.push_back(New);
2781 return QualType(New, 0);
2782}
2783
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002784/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2785/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002786/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002787QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2788 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002789 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002790 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2791 SourceRange brackets) const {
2792 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2793 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002794 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2795
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002796 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2797 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2798 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2799 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2800 if (!numElements) {
2801 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2802 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2803 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2804 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2805 brackets);
2806 Types.push_back(newType);
2807 return QualType(newType, 0);
2808 }
2809
2810 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2811 // also build a canonical type.
2812
2813 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2814
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002815 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002816 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002817 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002818 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002819 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002820
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002821 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2822 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2823 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002824
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002825 // If we don't have one, build one.
2826 if (!canonTy) {
2827 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002828 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002829 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2830 brackets);
2831 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2832 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002833 }
2834
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002835 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2836 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002837 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002838
David Majnemer16a74702015-07-24 05:54:19 +00002839 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size
2840 // expression, then just use that as our result.
2841 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType &&
2842 canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002843 return canon;
2844
2845 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2846 // of the element type.
2847 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2848 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2849 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2850 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2851 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2852 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002853}
2854
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002855QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002856 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002857 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002858 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002859 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002860
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002861 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002862 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2863 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2864 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002865
2866 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002867 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2868 // qualifiers off the element type.
2869 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002870
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002871 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2872 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002873 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002874 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002875 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002876
2877 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002878 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2879 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2880 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002881 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002882
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002883 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2884 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002885
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002886 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2887 Types.push_back(newType);
2888 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002889}
2890
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002891/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2892/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002893QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002894 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002895 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002896
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002897 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2898 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002899 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002900
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002901 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002902 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2903 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2904
2905 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2906 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2907 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002908 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002909 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002910
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002911 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2912 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002913 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002914 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002915 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002916 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002917 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2918 Types.push_back(New);
2919 return QualType(New, 0);
2920}
2921
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002922/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002923/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002924QualType
2925ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002926 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002927
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002928 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2929 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002930 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002931 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002932 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002933 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2934 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2935
2936 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2937 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2938 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002939 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002940 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002941
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002942 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2943 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002944 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002945 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002946 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2947 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002948 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2949 Types.push_back(New);
2950 return QualType(New, 0);
2951}
2952
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002953QualType
2954ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2955 Expr *SizeExpr,
2956 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002957 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002958 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002959 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002960
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002961 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002962 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2963 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2964 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2965 if (Canon) {
2966 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2967 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002968 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2969 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2970 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002971 } else {
2972 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2973 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002974 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2975 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2976 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002977
2978 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2979 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2980 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2981 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002982 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2983 } else {
2984 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2985 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002986 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2987 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002988 }
2989 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002990
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002991 Types.push_back(New);
2992 return QualType(New, 0);
2993}
2994
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00002995/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2996static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2997 return T.isCanonical() &&
2998 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2999 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
3000}
3001
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003002/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003003///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003004QualType
3005ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
3006 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003007 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3008 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00003009 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00003010 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003011
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003012 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003013 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003014 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003015 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003016
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003017 QualType Canonical;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003018 if (!isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy)) {
3019 Canonical =
3020 getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003021
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003022 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003023 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
3024 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003025 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003026 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003027
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003028 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003029 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, Info);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003030 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003031 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003032 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003033}
3034
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003035CanQualType
3036ASTContext::getCanonicalFunctionResultType(QualType ResultType) const {
3037 CanQualType CanResultType = getCanonicalType(ResultType);
3038
3039 // Canonical result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
3040 if (CanResultType.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
3041 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultType.getQualifiers();
3042 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
3043 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(
3044 getQualifiedType(CanResultType.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs));
3045 }
3046
3047 return CanResultType;
3048}
3049
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003050QualType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003051ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003052 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003053 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
3054
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003055 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3056 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00003057 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003058 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
3059 *this);
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00003060
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003061 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003062 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003063 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003064 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003065
3066 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003067 bool isCanonical =
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003068 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003069 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003070 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003071 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003072 isCanonical = false;
3073
3074 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003075 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003076 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00003077 if (!isCanonical) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003078 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003079 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3080 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003081 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003082
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003083 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003084 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003085 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003086
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003087 // Adjust the canonical function result type.
3088 CanQualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy);
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003089 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003090
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00003091 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003092 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
3093 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003094 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003095 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003096
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003097 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
3098 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
3099 // - parameter types
3100 // - exception types
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003101 // - extended parameter information
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003102 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003103 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
3104 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003105 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003106 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003107
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003108 if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
3109 Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3110 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00003111 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003112 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00003113 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003114 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003115 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003116 }
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003117
3118 // Put the ExtParameterInfos last. If all were equal, it would make
3119 // more sense to put these before the exception specification, because
3120 // it's much easier to skip past them compared to the elaborate switch
3121 // required to skip the exception specification. However, all is not
3122 // equal; ExtParameterInfos are used to model very uncommon features,
3123 // and it's better not to burden the more common paths.
3124 if (EPI.ExtParameterInfos) {
3125 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo);
3126 }
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003127
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003128 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00003129 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003130 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003131 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003132 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003133 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003134}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00003135
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003136/// Return pipe type for the specified type.
3137QualType ASTContext::getPipeType(QualType T) const {
3138 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3139 PipeType::Profile(ID, T);
3140
3141 void *InsertPos = 0;
3142 if (PipeType *PT = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3143 return QualType(PT, 0);
3144
3145 // If the pipe element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3146 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3147 QualType Canonical;
3148 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3149 Canonical = getPipeType(getCanonicalType(T));
3150
3151 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3152 PipeType *NewIP = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3153 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
3154 (void)NewIP;
3155 }
3156 PipeType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PipeType(T, Canonical);
3157 Types.push_back(New);
3158 PipeTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3159 return QualType(New, 0);
3160}
3161
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003162#ifndef NDEBUG
3163static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
3164 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
3165 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
3166 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3167 return true;
3168 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
3169 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3170 return true;
3171 return false;
3172}
3173#endif
3174
3175/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
3176/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
3177QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003178 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003179 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
3180 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
3181 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003182 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003183 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
3184 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3185 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3186 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003187 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003188 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003189 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3190 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003191 }
3192 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3193}
3194
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003195/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3196/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003197QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00003198 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003199 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003200
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003201 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003202 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003203
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003204 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3205 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3206
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003207 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003208 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003209 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003210 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003211 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003212 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003213 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003214 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00003215 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003216 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3217 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3218 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00003219 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003220 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003221
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003222 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003223}
3224
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00003225/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003226/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003227QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003228ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3229 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003230 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003231
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003232 if (Canonical.isNull())
3233 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003234 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003235 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003236 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3237 Types.push_back(newType);
3238 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00003239}
3240
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003241QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003242 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3243
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003244 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003245 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3246 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3247
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003248 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3249 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3250 Types.push_back(newType);
3251 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003252}
3253
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003254QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003255 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3256
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003257 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003258 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3259 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3260
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003261 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3262 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3263 Types.push_back(newType);
3264 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003265}
3266
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003267QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3268 QualType modifiedType,
3269 QualType equivalentType) {
3270 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3271 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3272
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003273 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003274 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3275 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3276
3277 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3278 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3279 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3280
3281 Types.push_back(type);
3282 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3283
3284 return QualType(type, 0);
3285}
3286
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003287/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3288QualType
3289ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003290 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003291 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003292 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3293
3294 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3295 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003296 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003297 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3298 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3299
3300 if (!SubstParm) {
3301 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3302 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3303 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3304 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3305 }
3306
3307 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3308}
3309
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003310/// \brief Retrieve a
3311QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3312 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3313 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3314#ifndef NDEBUG
Aaron Ballman2a89e852014-07-15 21:32:31 +00003315 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3316 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3317 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003318 }
3319#endif
3320
3321 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3322 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003323 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003324 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3325 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3326 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3327
3328 QualType Canon;
3329 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3330 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3331 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3332 ArgPack);
3333 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3334 }
3335
3336 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3337 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3338 ArgPack);
3339 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3340 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3341 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3342}
3343
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003344/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003345/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003346/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003347QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003348 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003349 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003350 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003351 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003352 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003353 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003354 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3355
3356 if (TypeParm)
3357 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003358
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003359 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003360 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003361 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003362
3363 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3364 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3365 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3366 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003367 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003368 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3369 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003370
3371 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3372 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3373
3374 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3375}
3376
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003377TypeSourceInfo *
3378ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3379 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3380 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003381 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003382 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3383 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003384 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003385
3386 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003387 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3388 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003389 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003390 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3391 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3392 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3393 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3394 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3395 return DI;
3396}
3397
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003398QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003399ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003400 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003401 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003402 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3403 "No dependent template names here!");
3404
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003405 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3406
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003407 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003408 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3409 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3410 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3411
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003412 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003413 Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003414}
3415
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003416#ifndef NDEBUG
3417static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3418 unsigned NumArgs) {
3419 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3420 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3421 return true;
3422
3423 return true;
3424}
3425#endif
3426
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003427QualType
3428ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003429 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3430 unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003431 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003432 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3433 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003434 // Look through qualified template names.
3435 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3436 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003437
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003438 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003439 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3440 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003441 QualType CanonType;
3442 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3443 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3444 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003445 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3446 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3447 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3448 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3449 IsTypeAlias = false;
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003450 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3451 NumArgs);
3452 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003453
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003454 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3455 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3456 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003457 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3458 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003459 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003460 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003461 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003462 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3463 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003464
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003465 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003466 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003467}
3468
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003469QualType
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003470ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3471 const TemplateArgument *Args,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003472 unsigned NumArgs) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003473 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3474 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003475
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003476 // Look through qualified template names.
3477 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3478 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003479
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003480 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3481 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003482 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003483 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3484 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3485 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3486
3487 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3488 // exists.
3489 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3490 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3491 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3492
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003493 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003494 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3495 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3496
3497 if (!Spec) {
3498 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3499 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3500 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3501 TypeAlignment);
3502 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3503 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003504 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003505 Types.push_back(Spec);
3506 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3507 }
3508
3509 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3510 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3511 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3512}
3513
3514QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003515ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3516 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003517 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003518 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003519 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003520
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003521 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003522 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003523 if (T)
3524 return QualType(T, 0);
3525
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003526 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3527 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3528 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003529 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3530 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003531 (void)CheckT;
3532 }
3533
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003534 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003535 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003536 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003537 return QualType(T, 0);
3538}
3539
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003540QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003541ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003542 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3543 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3544
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003545 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003546 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3547 if (T)
3548 return QualType(T, 0);
3549
3550 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3551 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3552 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3553 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3554 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3555 (void)CheckT;
3556 }
3557
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003558 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003559 Types.push_back(T);
3560 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3561 return QualType(T, 0);
3562}
3563
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003564QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3565 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3566 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003567 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003568 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3569 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003570 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3571 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3572 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3573
3574 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3575 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003576 }
3577
3578 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003579 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003580
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003581 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003582 DependentNameType *T
3583 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003584 if (T)
3585 return QualType(T, 0);
3586
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003587 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003588 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003589 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003590 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003591}
3592
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003593QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003594ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3595 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003596 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003597 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003598 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003599 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003600 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003601 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3602 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3603 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3604 ArgCopy.size(),
3605 ArgCopy.data());
3606}
3607
3608QualType
3609ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3610 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3611 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3612 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3613 unsigned NumArgs,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003614 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003615 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3616 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003617
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003618 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003619 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3620 Name, NumArgs, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003621
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003622 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003623 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3624 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003625 if (T)
3626 return QualType(T, 0);
3627
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003628 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003629
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003630 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3631 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3632
3633 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003634 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003635 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3636 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3637 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3638 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003639 }
3640
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003641 QualType Canon;
3642 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3643 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3644 Name, NumArgs,
3645 CanonArgs.data());
3646
3647 // Find the insert position again.
3648 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3649 }
3650
3651 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3652 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3653 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003654 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003655 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003656 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003657 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003658 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003659}
3660
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003661QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003662 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003663 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003664 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003665
3666 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3667 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003668 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003669 PackExpansionType *T
3670 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3671 if (T)
3672 return QualType(T, 0);
3673
3674 QualType Canon;
3675 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003676 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3677 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3678 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3679 // parameters.
3680 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003681 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003682
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003683 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3684 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3685 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3686 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003687 }
3688
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003689 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3690 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003691 Types.push_back(T);
3692 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003693 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003694}
3695
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003696/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3697/// alphabetically.
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003698static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
3699 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
3700 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003701}
3702
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00003703static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> Protocols) {
3704 if (Protocols.empty()) return true;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003705
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003706 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3707 return false;
3708
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00003709 for (unsigned i = 1; i != Protocols.size(); ++i)
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003710 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003711 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003712 return false;
3713 return true;
3714}
3715
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003716static void
3717SortAndUniqueProtocols(SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &Protocols) {
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003718 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003719 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end(), CmpProtocolNames);
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003720
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003721 // Canonicalize.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003722 for (ObjCProtocolDecl *&P : Protocols)
3723 P = P->getCanonicalDecl();
3724
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003725 // Remove duplicates.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003726 auto ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end());
3727 Protocols.erase(ProtocolsEnd, Protocols.end());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003728}
3729
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003730QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3731 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003732 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003733 return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, { },
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003734 llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols),
3735 /*isKindOf=*/false);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003736}
3737
3738QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(
3739 QualType baseType,
3740 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003741 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
3742 bool isKindOf) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003743 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or
3744 // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003745 if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf &&
3746 isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType))
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003747 return baseType;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003748
3749 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003750 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003751 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003752 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003753 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3754 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003755
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003756 // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization,
3757 // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base
3758 // type.
3759 ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs;
3760 if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) {
3761 if (auto baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
3762 effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs();
3763 }
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003764
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003765 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a
3766 // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments
3767 // canonicalized.
3768 QualType canonical;
3769 bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(),
3770 effectiveTypeArgs.end(),
3771 [&](QualType type) {
3772 return type.isCanonical();
3773 });
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00003774 bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003775 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) {
3776 // Determine the canonical type arguments.
3777 ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs;
3778 SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec;
3779 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) {
3780 canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size());
3781 for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs)
3782 canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg));
3783 canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003784 } else {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003785 canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003786 }
3787
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003788 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols;
3789 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec;
3790 if (!protocolsSorted) {
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003791 canonProtocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
3792 SortAndUniqueProtocols(canonProtocolsVec);
3793 canonProtocols = canonProtocolsVec;
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003794 } else {
3795 canonProtocols = protocols;
3796 }
3797
3798 canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003799 canonProtocols, isKindOf);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003800
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003801 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003802 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3803 }
3804
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003805 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3806 size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3807 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3808 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003809 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003810 new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols,
3811 isKindOf);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003812
3813 Types.push_back(T);
3814 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3815 return QualType(T, 0);
3816}
3817
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003818/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3819/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3820/// list.
3821bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3822 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3823 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3824 return false;
3825
3826 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3827 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003828 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003829 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3830 return false;
3831 }
3832 return true;
3833 }
3834 return false;
3835}
3836
3837/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3838/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3839/// of protocols.
3840bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3841 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3842 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3843 return false;
3844 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3845 if (!OPT)
3846 return false;
3847 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3848 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003849 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3850 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3851 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3852 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003853 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
3854 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
3855 bool Conforms = false;
3856 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3857 Conforms = false;
3858 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3859 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
3860 Conforms = true;
3861 break;
3862 }
3863 }
3864 if (!Conforms)
3865 break;
3866 }
3867 if (Conforms)
3868 return true;
3869
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003870 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003871 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3872 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003873 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003874 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003875 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003876 break;
3877 }
3878 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003879 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003880 }
3881 return true;
3882}
3883
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003884/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3885/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003886QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003887 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3888 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3889
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003890 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003891 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3892 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3893 return QualType(QT, 0);
3894
3895 // Find the canonical object type.
3896 QualType Canonical;
3897 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3898 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3899
3900 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003901 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3902 }
3903
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003904 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003905 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3906 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3907 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003908
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003909 Types.push_back(QType);
3910 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003911 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003912}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003913
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003914/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3915/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003916QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3917 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003918 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3919 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003920
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003921 if (PrevDecl) {
3922 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3923 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3924 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3925 }
3926
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003927 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3928 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3929 Decl = Def;
3930
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003931 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3932 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3933 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3934 Types.push_back(T);
3935 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003936}
3937
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003938/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3939/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003940/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003941/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003942/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003943QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003944 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003945 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3946 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3947 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003948
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003949 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003950 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3951 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3952 if (Canon) {
3953 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3954 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003955 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003956 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003957 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003958 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003959 Canon
3960 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003961 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3962 toe = Canon;
3963 }
3964 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003965 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003966 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003967 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003968 Types.push_back(toe);
3969 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003970}
3971
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003972/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003973/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003974/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003975/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
3976/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003977QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003978 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003979 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003980 Types.push_back(tot);
3981 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003982}
3983
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003984/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
3985/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
3986/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
3987/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003988QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003989 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003990
3991 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003992 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003993 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3994 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003995 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003996 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3997 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003998
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003999 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004000 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
4001 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004002 if (!Canon) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004003 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004004 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004005 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004006 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004007 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4008 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004009 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004010 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4011 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004012 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00004013 Types.push_back(dt);
4014 return QualType(dt, 0);
4015}
4016
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004017/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
4018/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
4019QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
4020 QualType UnderlyingType,
4021 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
4022 const {
4023 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
Douglas Gregor6c6e6762011-05-25 17:51:54 +00004024 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
4025 Kind,
4026 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
Peter Collingbourne15d48ec2012-03-05 16:02:06 +00004027 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004028 Types.push_back(Ty);
4029 return QualType(Ty, 0);
4030}
4031
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004032/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
4033/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
4034/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004035QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004036 bool IsDependent) const {
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004037 if (DeducedType.isNull() && Keyword == AutoTypeKeyword::Auto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004038 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004039
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004040 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004041 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004042 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004043 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004044 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4045 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004046
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00004047 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004048 Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004049 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004050 Types.push_back(AT);
4051 if (InsertPos)
4052 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
4053 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00004054}
4055
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004056/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
4057/// the given value type.
4058QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
4059 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
4060 // structure.
4061 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4062 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
4063
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004064 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004065 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4066 return QualType(AT, 0);
4067
4068 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
4069 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
4070 QualType Canonical;
4071 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
4072 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
4073
4074 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4075 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004076 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004077 }
4078 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
4079 Types.push_back(New);
4080 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4081 return QualType(New, 0);
4082}
4083
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004084/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
4085QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
4086 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004087 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004088 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), AutoTypeKeyword::Auto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004089 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004090 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004091 return AutoDeductTy;
4092}
4093
4094/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
4095QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
4096 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
4097 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
4098 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
4099 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
4100}
4101
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004102/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4103/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004104QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00004105 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00004106 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
4107 // away const? mutable?
4108 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004109}
4110
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004111/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
4112/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
4113/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00004114CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004115 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00004116}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004117
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004118/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4119CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
4120 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
4121}
4122
4123/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4124CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
4125 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
4126}
4127
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00004128/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
4129/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4130QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
4131 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4132 return WCharTy;
4133}
4134
4135/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
4136/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4137QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
4138 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4139 return UnsignedIntTy;
4140}
4141
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00004142QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
4143 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
4144}
4145
4146QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
4147 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
4148}
4149
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004150/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004151/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
4152QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004153 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004154}
4155
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00004156/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
4157/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
4158QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
4159 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
4160}
4161
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004162//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4163// Type Operators
4164//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4165
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004166CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004167 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
4168 // qualifiers.
4169 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00004170 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004171 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004172 QualType Result;
4173 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
4174 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
4175 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
4176 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
4177 } else {
4178 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
4179 }
4180
4181 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
4182}
4183
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004184QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
4185 Qualifiers &quals) {
4186 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
4187
4188 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
4189 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
4190 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
4191 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
4192 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004193 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004194
4195 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004196 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004197 quals = splitType.Quals;
4198 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004199 }
4200
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004201 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
4202 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
4203 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
4204
4205 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
4206 // can just use the results in splitType.
4207 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
4208 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004209 quals = splitType.Quals;
4210 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004211 }
4212
4213 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
4214 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004215 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004216
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004217 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004218 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004219 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4220 }
4221
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004222 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004223 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004224 }
4225
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004226 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004227 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004228 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004229 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4230 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4231 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4232 }
4233
4234 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004235 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004236 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4237 SourceRange());
4238}
4239
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004240/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
4241/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4242/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4243/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4244/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4245/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4246/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4247/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
4248bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4249 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4250 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4251 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4252 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4253 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4254 return true;
4255 }
4256
4257 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4258 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4259 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4260 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4261 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4262 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4263 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4264 return true;
4265 }
4266
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004267 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004268 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4269 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4270 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4271 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4272 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4273 return true;
4274 }
4275 }
4276
4277 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4278
4279 return false;
4280}
4281
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004282DeclarationNameInfo
4283ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4284 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004285 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4286 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4287 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004288 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004289 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4290 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004291
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004292 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4293 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4294 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4295 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4296 }
4297
4298 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4299 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004300 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004301 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004302 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4303 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004304 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004305 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4306 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4307 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4308 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4309 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4310 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004311 }
4312 }
4313
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004314 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4315 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4316 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4317 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4318 NameLoc);
4319 }
4320
4321 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4322 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4323 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4324 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4325 NameLoc);
4326 }
4327 }
4328
4329 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004330}
4331
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004332TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004333 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4334 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4335 case TemplateName::Template: {
4336 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004337 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004338 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004339 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4340
4341 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004342 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004343 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004344
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004345 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4346 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004347
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004348 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4349 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4350 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4351 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4352 }
4353
4354 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4355 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4356 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4357 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4358 }
4359
4360 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4361 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4362 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4363 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4364 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4365 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4366 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4367 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4368 }
4369 }
4370
4371 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004372}
4373
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004374bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4375 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4376 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4377 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4378}
4379
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004380TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004381ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004382 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4383 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4384 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004385
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004386 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004387 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004388
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004389 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004390 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
David Blaikie952a9b12014-10-17 18:00:12 +00004391 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004392 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004393
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004394 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4395 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4396 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4397
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004398 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4399 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004400
4401 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4402 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4403 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004404 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004405
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004406 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004407 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004408
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004409 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004410 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004411
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004412 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004413 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4414 return Arg;
4415
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004416 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4417 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004418 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004419 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004420 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4421 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4422 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004423
Benjamin Kramercce63472015-08-05 09:40:22 +00004424 return TemplateArgument(llvm::makeArrayRef(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size()));
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004425 }
4426 }
4427
4428 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004429 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004430}
4431
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004432NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004433ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004434 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004435 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004436
4437 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4438 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4439 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004440 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004441 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4442 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4443
4444 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4445 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4446 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004447 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004448 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4449
4450 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4451 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4452 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004453 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004454 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4455 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004456
4457 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4458 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4459 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004460
4461 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4462 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4463 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4464 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4465 // types, e.g.,
4466 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4467 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004468 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4469 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004470 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004471
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004472 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4473 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4474 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004475 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4476 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004477 }
4478
4479 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
Nikola Smiljanic67860242014-09-26 00:28:20 +00004480 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
4481 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004482 return NNS;
4483 }
4484
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004485 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004486}
4487
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004488const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004489 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004490 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004491 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4492 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4493 return AT;
4494 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004495
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004496 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004497 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004498 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004499
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004500 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004501 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4502 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004503
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004504 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4505 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004506 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004507
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004508 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004509 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004510
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004511 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004512 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004513 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004514 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004515
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004516 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4517 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004518 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004519
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004520 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4521 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4522 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004523 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004524 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4525 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4526 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004527 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004528
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004529 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004530 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4531 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004532 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004533 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004534 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004535 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004536 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004537
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004538 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004539 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004540 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004541 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004542 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004543 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004544}
4545
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004546QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004547 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4548 return getDecayedType(T);
4549 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004550}
4551
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004552QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004553 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4554 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4555 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4556}
4557
David Majnemerd09a51c2015-03-03 01:50:05 +00004558QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
4559 // C++ [except.throw]p3:
4560 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
4561 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
4562 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
4563 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
4564 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
4565 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4566 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4567 T = getDecayedType(T);
4568 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4569}
4570
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004571/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4572/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4573/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4574/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4575///
4576/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004577QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004578 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4579 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4580 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4581 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4582 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4583 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004584
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004585 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004586
4587 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004588 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004589}
4590
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004591QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4592 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004593}
4594
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004595QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4596 Qualifiers qs;
4597 while (true) {
4598 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004599 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004600 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004601
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004602 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004603 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004604 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004605
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004606 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004607}
4608
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004609/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004610uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004611ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4612 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4613 do {
4614 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004615 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4616 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004617 } while (CA);
4618 return ElementCount;
4619}
4620
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004621/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4622/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004623static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004624 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004625 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004626
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004627 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4628 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004629 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004630 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004631 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4632 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4633 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004634 }
4635}
4636
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004637/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4638/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004639/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4640/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004641QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4642 QualType Domain) const {
4643 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4644 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4645 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004646 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004647 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4648 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4649 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4650 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004651 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004652
4653 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4654 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004655 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004656 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4657 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4658 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004659 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004660 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004661}
4662
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004663/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4664/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4665/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004666/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004667int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004668 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4669 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004670
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004671 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004672 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004673 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004674 return 1;
4675 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004676}
4677
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004678/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4679/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4680/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004681unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004682 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004683
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004684 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004685 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004686 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004687 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004688 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4689 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4690 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4691 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004692 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004693 case BuiltinType::Short:
4694 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004695 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004696 case BuiltinType::Int:
4697 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004698 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004699 case BuiltinType::Long:
4700 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004701 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004702 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4703 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004704 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004705 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4706 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4707 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004708 }
4709}
4710
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004711/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4712/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4713///
4714/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4715/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004716QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004717 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4718 return QualType();
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004719
4720 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
4721 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
4722 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
4723
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004724 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004725 if (!Field)
4726 return QualType();
4727
4728 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4729
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004730 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004731 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004732 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
4733 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
4734 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
4735 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
4736 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
4737 // promotion applies to it.
4738 // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
4739 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
4740 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
4741 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
4742 // it is converted to an unsigned int.
4743 //
4744 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
4745 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004746 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4747 return IntTy;
4748
4749 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4750 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4751
4752 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004753 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
4754 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
4755 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
4756 // into their semantics in some cases).
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004757 return QualType();
4758}
4759
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004760/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4761/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4762/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004763QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004764 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4765 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004766 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4767 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004768
4769 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4770 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4771 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4772 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4773 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4774 // unsigned long long int [...]
4775 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4776 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4777 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4778 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4779 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4780 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4781 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4782 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4783 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4784 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4785 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4786 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4787 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4788 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4789 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4790 }
4791 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4792 }
4793 }
4794
4795 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004796 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4797 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004798 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4799 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004800 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4801 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4802}
4803
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004804/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4805/// type and returns its ownership.
4806Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4807 while (!T.isNull()) {
4808 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4809 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4810 if (T->isArrayType())
4811 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4812 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4813 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4814 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004815 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004816 else
4817 break;
4818 }
4819
4820 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4821}
4822
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004823static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4824 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4825 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4826 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4827 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004828 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004829}
4830
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004831/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004832/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004833/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004834int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004835 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4836 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004837
4838 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4839 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4840 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4841 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4842 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4843
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004844 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004845
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004846 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4847 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004848
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004849 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4850 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004851
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004852 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4853 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4854 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4855 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004856
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004857 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4858 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4859 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4860 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4861 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004862
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004863 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4864 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004865 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004866 return -1;
4867 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004868
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004869 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4870 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4871 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004872
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004873 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4874 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004875 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004876 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004877}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004878
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004879TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringDecl() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004880 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004881 assert(!CFConstantStringTagDecl &&
4882 "tag and typedef should be initialized together");
4883 CFConstantStringTagDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__NSConstantString_tag");
4884 CFConstantStringTagDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004885
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004886 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00004887 const char *FieldNames[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004888
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004889 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004890 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00004891 FieldNames[0] = "isa";
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004892 // int flags;
4893 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00004894 FieldNames[1] = "flags";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004895 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004896 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00004897 FieldNames[2] = "str";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004898 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004899 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00004900 FieldNames[3] = "length";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004901
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004902 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004903 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004904 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTagDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004905 SourceLocation(),
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00004906 SourceLocation(),
4907 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004908 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4909 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004910 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004911 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004912 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004913 CFConstantStringTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004914 }
4915
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004916 CFConstantStringTagDecl->completeDefinition();
4917 // This type is designed to be compatible with NSConstantString, but cannot
4918 // use the same name, since NSConstantString is an interface.
4919 auto tagType = getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTagDecl);
4920 CFConstantStringTypeDecl =
4921 buildImplicitTypedef(tagType, "__NSConstantString");
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004922 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004923
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00004924 return CFConstantStringTypeDecl;
4925}
4926
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004927RecordDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringTagDecl() const {
4928 if (!CFConstantStringTagDecl)
4929 getCFConstantStringDecl(); // Build the tag and the typedef.
4930 return CFConstantStringTagDecl;
4931}
4932
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00004933// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
4934QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004935 return getTypedefType(getCFConstantStringDecl());
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004936}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004937
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004938QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4939 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004940 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004941 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4942 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4943 }
4944 return ObjCSuperType;
4945}
4946
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004947void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004948 const TypedefType *TD = T->getAs<TypedefType>();
4949 assert(TD && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4950 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = cast<TypedefDecl>(TD->getDecl());
4951 auto TagType =
4952 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<RecordType>();
4953 assert(TagType && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4954 CFConstantStringTagDecl = TagType->getDecl();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004955}
4956
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004957QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004958 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4959 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4960
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004961 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004962 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004963 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4964 RD->startDefinition();
4965
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004966 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4967 UnsignedLongTy,
4968 UnsignedLongTy,
4969 };
4970
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004971 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004972 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004973 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004974 };
4975
4976 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004977 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4978 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004979 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4980 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004981 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004982 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004983 }
4984
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004985 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004986
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004987 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004988
4989 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4990}
4991
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004992QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004993 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4994 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4995
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004996 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004997 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004998 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
4999 RD->startDefinition();
5000
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005001 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
5002 UnsignedLongTy,
5003 UnsignedLongTy,
5004 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
5005 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
5006 };
5007
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00005008 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005009 "reserved",
5010 "Size",
5011 "CopyFuncPtr",
5012 "DestroyFuncPtr"
5013 };
5014
5015 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005016 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
5017 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005018 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5019 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005020 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005021 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005022 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005023 }
5024
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005025 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005026
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005027 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005028 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5029}
5030
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005031/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
5032/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
5033/// in buildByrefHelpers.
5034bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
5035 const VarDecl *D) {
5036 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
5037 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
5038 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
5039
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005040 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00005041 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005042
5043 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
5044
5045 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
5046
5047 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
5048 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005049 switch (lifetime) {
5050 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
5051
5052 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
5053 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
5054 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
5055 return false;
5056
5057 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
5058 // byref routines.
5059 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
5060 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
5061 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
5062 return true;
5063 }
5064 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
5065 }
5066 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
5067 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005068}
5069
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005070bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
5071 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
5072 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
5073
5074 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
5075 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
5076 return false;
5077
5078 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00005079 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005080 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
5081 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005082 } else if ((LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime())) {
5083 // Honor the ARC qualifiers.
5084 } else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) {
5085 // The MRR rule.
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005086 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005087 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005088 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005089 }
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005090 return true;
5091}
5092
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005093TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
5094 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005095 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
5096 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005097 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
5098}
5099
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005100// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
5101// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00005102static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005103 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00005104 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
5105 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005106
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005107 return false;
5108}
5109
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005110/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005111/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005112CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005113 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
5114 return CharUnits::Zero();
5115
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005116 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005117
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005118 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00005119 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005120 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005121 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
5122 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005123 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005124 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005125}
5126
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005127bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00005128 return getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
5129 VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
David Majnemerfac52432015-10-19 23:22:49 +00005130 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5131 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005132}
5133
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005134static inline
5135std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
5136 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005137}
5138
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005139/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005140/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005141std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
5142 std::string S;
5143
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005144 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
5145 QualType BlockTy =
5146 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5147 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005148 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005149 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
5150 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
5151 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005152 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005153 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005154 // Compute size of all parameters.
5155 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5156 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5157 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005158 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5159 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00005160 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
5161 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005162 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00005163 if (sz.isZero())
5164 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005165 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005166 ParmOffset += sz;
5167 }
5168 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005169 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005170 // Block pointer and offset.
5171 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005172
5173 // Argument types.
5174 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00005175 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005176 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5177 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5178 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5179 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5180 // elements.
5181 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5182 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5183 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5184 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005185 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005186 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
5187 S, true /*Extended*/);
5188 else
5189 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005190 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005191 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005192 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005193
5194 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005195}
5196
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005197bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005198 std::string& S) {
5199 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005200 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005201 CharUnits ParmOffset;
5202 // Compute size of all parameters.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00005203 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
5204 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005205 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005206 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005207 continue;
5208
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005209 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005210 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005211 ParmOffset += sz;
5212 }
5213 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5214 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
5215
5216 // Argument types.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00005217 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005218 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5219 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5220 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5221 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5222 // elements.
5223 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5224 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5225 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5226 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5227 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5228 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5229 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5230 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005231
5232 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005233}
5234
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005235/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
5236/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
5237/// block object types.
5238void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5239 QualType T, std::string& S,
5240 bool Extended) const {
5241 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
5242 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
5243 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005244 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005245 true /*OutermostType*/,
5246 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
5247 false /*StructField*/,
5248 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
5249 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
5250}
5251
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005252/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005253/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005254bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005255 std::string& S,
5256 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005257 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005258 // Encode return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005259 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5260 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005261 // Compute size of all parameters.
5262 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5263 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5264 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005265 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005266 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
5267 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005268 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005269 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005270 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00005271 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005272 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005273 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005274 continue;
5275
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005276 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
5277 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005278 ParmOffset += sz;
5279 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005280 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005281 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005282 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005283
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005284 // Argument types.
5285 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005286 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005287 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005288 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005289 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00005290 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005291 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5292 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5293 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00005294 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005295 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5296 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5297 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005298 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5299 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005300 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005301 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005302 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005303
5304 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005305}
5306
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005307ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
5308ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
5309 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5310 const Decl *Container) const {
5311 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005312 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005313 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
5314 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00005315 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
5316 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5317 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005318 } else {
5319 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
5320 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
5321 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5322 return PID;
5323 }
5324 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005325}
5326
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005327/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005328/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005329/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
5330/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005331/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
5332/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
5333/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
5334/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
5335/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005336/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
5337/// @code
5338/// enum PropertyAttributes {
5339/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
5340/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
5341/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
5342/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
5343/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
5344/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
5345/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00005346/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005347/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5348/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5349/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5350/// };
5351/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005352void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005353 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005354 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005355 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5356 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005357 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005358
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005359 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5360 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5361 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5362 Dynamic = true;
5363 else
5364 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005365 }
5366
5367 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5368 S = "T";
5369
5370 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005371 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5372 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005373 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005374
5375 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5376 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005377 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5378 S += ",C";
5379 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5380 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00005381 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5382 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005383 } else {
5384 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5385 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5386 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005387 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005388 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005389 }
5390 }
5391
5392 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5393 // are "dynamic by default".
5394 if (Dynamic)
5395 S += ",D";
5396
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005397 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5398 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005399
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005400 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5401 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005402 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005403 }
5404
5405 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5406 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005407 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005408 }
5409
5410 if (SynthesizePID) {
5411 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5412 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005413 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005414 }
5415
5416 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5417}
5418
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005419/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005420/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5421/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005422/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5423///
5424void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005425 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005426 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005427 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005428 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005429 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005430 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005431 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5432 }
5433 }
5434}
5435
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005436void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005437 const FieldDecl *Field,
5438 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005439 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5440 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5441 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5442 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005443 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005444 true /* outermost type */, false, false,
5445 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005446}
5447
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005448void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5449 std::string& S) const {
5450 // Encode result type.
5451 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5452 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5453 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5454 true /* outermost type */,
5455 true /* encoding property */);
5456}
5457
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005458static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5459 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5460 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005461 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5462 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5463 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5464 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005465 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005466 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005467 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005468 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5469 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005470 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005471 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5472 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5473 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5474 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5475 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005476 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5477 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005478 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5479 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005480 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005481 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5482 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5483 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5484 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005485 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005486 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5487
5488 case BuiltinType::Half:
5489 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5490 return ' ';
5491
5492 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5493 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5494 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5495 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5496
5497 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5498 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5499 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5500 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5501 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5502 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00005503 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dDepth:
5504 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayDepth:
5505 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAA:
5506 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAA:
5507 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAADepth:
5508 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepth:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005509 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005510 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00005511 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
5512 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
5513 case BuiltinType::OCLNDRange:
5514 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005515 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005516 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5517#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5518#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5519 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5520#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5521 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005522 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005523 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005524}
5525
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005526static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5527 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5528
5529 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5530 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5531 return 'i';
5532
5533 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005534 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5535 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005536}
5537
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005538static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005539 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005540 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005541 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005542 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5543 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5544 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5545 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5546 //
5547 // struct
5548 // {
5549 // int integer;
5550 // int flags:2;
5551 // };
5552 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5553 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5554 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5555 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5556 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005557 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005558 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5559 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005560 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005561 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5562 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005563 else {
5564 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5565 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5566 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005567 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005568 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005569}
5570
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005571// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005572void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5573 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5574 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005575 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005576 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005577 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005578 bool StructField,
5579 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005580 bool EncodeClassNames,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005581 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5582 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005583 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5584 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5585 case Type::Builtin:
5586 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005587 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005588 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005589 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5590 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5591 else
5592 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005593 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005594
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005595 case Type::Complex: {
5596 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005597 S += 'j';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005598 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005599 return;
5600 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005601
5602 case Type::Atomic: {
5603 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5604 S += 'A';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005605 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005606 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005607 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005608
5609 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5610 case Type::Pointer:
5611 case Type::LValueReference:
5612 case Type::RValueReference: {
5613 QualType PointeeTy;
5614 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5615 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5616 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5617 S += ':';
5618 return;
5619 }
5620 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5621 } else {
5622 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5623 }
5624
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005625 bool isReadOnly = false;
5626 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5627 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5628 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005629 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005630 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005631 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5632 isReadOnly = true;
5633 S += 'r';
5634 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005635 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005636 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005637 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5638 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005639 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5640 isReadOnly = true;
5641 S += 'r';
5642 }
5643 }
5644 if (isReadOnly) {
5645 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5646 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5647 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005648 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005649 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005650 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005651
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005652 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5653 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5654 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005655 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005656 S += '*';
5657 return;
5658 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005659 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005660 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5661 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5662 S += '#';
5663 return;
5664 }
5665 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5666 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5667 S += '@';
5668 return;
5669 }
5670 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005671 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005672 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005673 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5674
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005675 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005676 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
5677 NotEncodedT);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005678 return;
5679 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005680
5681 case Type::ConstantArray:
5682 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5683 case Type::VariableArray: {
5684 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5685
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005686 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005687 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5688 S += '^';
5689
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005690 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005691 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5692 } else {
5693 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005694
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00005695 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5696 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5697 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005698 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005699 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5700 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005701 S += '0';
5702 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005703
5704 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005705 false, ExpandStructures, FD,
5706 false, false, false, false, false, false,
5707 NotEncodedT);
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005708 S += ']';
5709 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005710 return;
5711 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005712
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005713 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5714 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005715 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005716 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005717
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005718 case Type::Record: {
5719 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005720 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005721 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5722 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5723 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005724 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5725 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5726 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005727 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5728 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005729 TemplateArgs.data(),
5730 TemplateArgs.size(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005731 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005732 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005733 } else {
5734 S += '?';
5735 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005736 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005737 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005738 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005739 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005740 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005741 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005742 if (FD) {
5743 S += '"';
5744 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5745 S += '"';
5746 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005747
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005748 // Special case bit-fields.
5749 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5750 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005751 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005752 } else {
5753 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5754 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5755 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5756 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5757 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005758 /*StructField*/true,
5759 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005760 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005761 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005762 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005763 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005764 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005765 return;
5766 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005767
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005768 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5769 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005770 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005771 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005772 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005773
5774 S += '<';
5775 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005776 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5777 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5778 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005779 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
5780 NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005781 // Block self
5782 S += "@?";
5783 // Block parameters
5784 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00005785 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
5786 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5787 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
5788 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005789 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
5790 false, NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005791 }
5792 S += '>';
5793 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005794 return;
5795 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005796
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00005797 case Type::ObjCObject: {
5798 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5799 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5800 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5801 S += "{objc_object=}";
5802 return;
5803 }
5804 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5805 S += "{objc_class=}";
5806 return;
5807 }
5808 }
5809
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005810 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5811 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005812 // @encode(class_name)
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00005813 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005814 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005815 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005816 S += '=';
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005817 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005818 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5819 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005820 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005821 if (Field->isBitField())
5822 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005823 else
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005824 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5825 false, false, false, false, false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005826 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5827 NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005828 }
5829 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005830 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005831 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005832
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005833 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5834 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005835 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5836 S += '@';
5837 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005838 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005839
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005840 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5841 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5842 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5843 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005844 S += '#';
5845 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005846 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005847
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005848 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005849 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005850 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5851 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005852 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005853 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5854 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005855 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005856 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005857 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005858 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005859 S += '>';
5860 }
5861 S += '"';
5862 }
5863 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005864 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005865
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005866 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5867 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005868 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5869 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005870 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005871 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005872 // {...};
5873 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005874 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00005875 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005876 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5877 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5878 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5879 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5880 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5881 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005882 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005883 S += '}';
5884 return;
5885 }
5886 }
5887 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005888 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5889 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005890 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005891 false, false, false, false, false,
5892 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005893 return;
5894 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005895
5896 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005897 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5898 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005899 S += '"';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005900 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005901 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005902 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005903 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005904 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005905 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005906 S += '"';
5907 }
5908 return;
5909 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005910
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005911 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005912 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5913 case Type::MemberPointer:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005914 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
5915 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005916 case Type::Vector:
5917 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005918 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
5919 { if (NotEncodedT)
5920 *NotEncodedT = T;
5921 return;
5922 }
5923
5924 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5925 // Just ignore it.
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005926 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005927 return;
5928
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00005929 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005930#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5931#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5932#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5933 case Type::KIND:
5934#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5935 case Type::KIND:
5936#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5937 case Type::KIND:
5938#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5939 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005940 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005941 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005942}
5943
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005944void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5945 std::string &S,
5946 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005947 bool includeVBases,
5948 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005949 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5950 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
Argyrios Kyrtzidis785705b2016-01-16 00:20:02 +00005951 if (!RDecl->getDefinition() || RDecl->getDefinition()->isInvalidDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005952 return;
5953
5954 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5955 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5956 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5957
5958 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00005959 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5960 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5961 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005962 if (base->isEmpty())
5963 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005964 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005965 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5966 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5967 }
5968 }
5969 }
5970
5971 unsigned i = 0;
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00005972 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005973 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5974 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00005975 std::make_pair(offs, Field));
5976 ++i;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005977 }
5978
5979 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00005980 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
5981 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005982 if (base->isEmpty())
5983 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005984 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00005985 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5986 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00005987 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5988 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005989 }
5990 }
5991
5992 CharUnits size;
5993 if (CXXRec) {
5994 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5995 } else {
5996 size = layout.getSize();
5997 }
5998
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005999#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006000 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006001#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006002 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
6003 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
6004
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00006005 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
6006 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006007 if (FD) {
6008 S += "\"_vptr$";
6009 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
6010 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
6011 S += recname;
6012 S += '"';
6013 }
6014 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006015#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006016 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006017#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006018 }
6019
6020 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
6021 // Mark the end of the structure.
6022 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
6023 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006024 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006025 }
6026
6027 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006028#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006029 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006030 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
6031 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
6032 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
6033 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
6034 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
6035 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
6036 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
6037 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
6038 // longer then though.
6039 CurOffs += padding;
6040 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006041#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006042
6043 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006044 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006045 break; // reached end of structure.
6046
6047 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
6048 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
6049 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
6050 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
6051 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006052 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
6053 NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006054 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006055#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006056 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006057#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006058 } else {
6059 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
6060 if (FD) {
6061 S += '"';
6062 S += field->getNameAsString();
6063 S += '"';
6064 }
6065
6066 if (field->isBitField()) {
6067 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006068#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006069 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006070#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006071 } else {
6072 QualType qt = field->getType();
6073 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6074 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
6075 /*OutermostType*/false,
6076 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006077 /*StructField*/true,
6078 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006079#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006080 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006081#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006082 }
6083 }
6084 }
6085}
6086
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006087void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00006088 std::string& S) const {
6089 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
6090 S += 'n';
6091 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
6092 S += 'N';
6093 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
6094 S += 'o';
6095 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
6096 S += 'O';
6097 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
6098 S += 'R';
6099 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
6100 S += 'V';
6101}
6102
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006103TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
6104 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00006105 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, { }, { });
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006106 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006107 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006108 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006109 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00006110}
6111
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006112TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
6113 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006114 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
6115 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006116 }
6117 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00006118}
6119
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006120TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
6121 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00006122 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, { }, { });
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006123 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006124 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006125 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006126 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00006127}
6128
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006129ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
6130 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
6131 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
6132 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6133 SourceLocation(),
6134 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Douglas Gregor85f3f952015-07-07 03:57:15 +00006135 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006136 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006137 SourceLocation(), true);
6138 }
6139
6140 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
6141}
6142
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006143//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6144// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
6145//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6146
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006147static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6148 StringRef Name) {
6149 // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006150 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006151 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name);
6152}
6153
6154static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6155 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list");
6156}
6157
6158static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6159 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006160}
6161
6162static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6163 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006164 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6165 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006166}
6167
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006168static TypedefDecl *
6169CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006170 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006171 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006172 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6173 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6174 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6175 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6176 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006177 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006178 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006179 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006180 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006181 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006182 }
6183
6184 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6185
6186 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6187 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6188 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6189
6190 // void *__stack;
6191 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6192 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
6193
6194 // void *__gr_top;
6195 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6196 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
6197
6198 // void *__vr_top;
6199 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6200 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
6201
6202 // int __gr_offs;
6203 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
6204 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
6205
6206 // int __vr_offs;
6207 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
6208 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
6209
6210 // Create fields
6211 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6212 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6213 VaListTagDecl,
6214 SourceLocation(),
6215 SourceLocation(),
6216 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006217 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6218 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006219 /*Mutable=*/false,
6220 ICIS_NoInit);
6221 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6222 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6223 }
6224 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006225 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006226 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006227
6228 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006229 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006230}
6231
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006232static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6233 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6234 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6235
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006236 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006237 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6238
6239 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6240 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6241 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6242
6243 // unsigned char gpr;
6244 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6245 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
6246
6247 // unsigned char fpr;
6248 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6249 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
6250
6251 // unsigned short reserved;
6252 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
6253 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
6254
6255 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6256 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6257 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
6258
6259 // void* reg_save_area;
6260 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6261 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
6262
6263 // Create fields
6264 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6265 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
6266 SourceLocation(),
6267 SourceLocation(),
6268 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006269 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6270 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006271 /*Mutable=*/false,
6272 ICIS_NoInit);
6273 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6274 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6275 }
6276 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006277 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006278 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6279
6280 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006281 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6282 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6283
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006284 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6285 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6286
6287 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6288 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6289 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6290 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6291 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006292 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006293}
6294
6295static TypedefDecl *
6296CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006297 // struct __va_list_tag {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006298 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006299 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006300 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6301
6302 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6303 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6304 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6305
6306 // unsigned gp_offset;
6307 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6308 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
6309
6310 // unsigned fp_offset;
6311 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6312 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
6313
6314 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6315 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6316 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
6317
6318 // void* reg_save_area;
6319 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6320 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
6321
6322 // Create fields
6323 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6324 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6325 VaListTagDecl,
6326 SourceLocation(),
6327 SourceLocation(),
6328 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006329 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6330 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006331 /*Mutable=*/false,
6332 ICIS_NoInit);
6333 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6334 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6335 }
6336 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006337 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006338 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6339
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006340 // };
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006341
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006342 // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006343 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006344 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
6345 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006346 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006347}
6348
6349static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6350 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
6351 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
6352 QualType IntArrayType
6353 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
6354 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006355 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006356}
6357
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006358static TypedefDecl *
6359CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006360 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006361 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006362 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6363 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6364 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6365 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6366 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6367 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6368 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006369 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006370 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006371 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006372 }
6373
6374 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6375
6376 // void * __ap;
6377 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6378 VaListDecl,
6379 SourceLocation(),
6380 SourceLocation(),
6381 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6382 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006383 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6384 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006385 /*Mutable=*/false,
6386 ICIS_NoInit);
6387 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6388 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6389
6390 // };
6391 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6392
6393 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006394 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6395 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006396}
6397
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006398static TypedefDecl *
6399CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006400 // struct __va_list_tag {
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006401 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006402 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006403 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6404
6405 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6406 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6407 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6408
6409 // long __gpr;
6410 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6411 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6412
6413 // long __fpr;
6414 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6415 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6416
6417 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6418 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6419 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6420
6421 // void *__reg_save_area;
6422 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6423 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6424
6425 // Create fields
6426 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6427 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6428 VaListTagDecl,
6429 SourceLocation(),
6430 SourceLocation(),
6431 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006432 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6433 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006434 /*Mutable=*/false,
6435 ICIS_NoInit);
6436 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6437 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6438 }
6439 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006440 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006441 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006442
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006443 // };
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006444
6445 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6446 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006447 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
6448 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006449
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006450 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006451}
6452
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006453static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6454 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6455 switch (Kind) {
6456 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6457 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6458 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6459 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006460 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6461 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006462 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6463 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6464 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6465 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6466 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6467 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006468 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6469 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006470 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6471 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006472 }
6473
6474 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6475}
6476
6477TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006478 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006479 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006480 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6481 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006482
6483 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6484}
6485
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006486Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const {
6487 // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006488 // declaration.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006489 if (!VaListTagDecl)
6490 (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl();
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006491
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006492 return VaListTagDecl;
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006493}
6494
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006495TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const {
6496 if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl)
6497 BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this);
6498
6499 return BuiltinMSVaListDecl;
6500}
6501
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006502void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006503 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006504 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006505
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006506 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006507}
6508
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006509/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6510/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006511TemplateName
6512ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6513 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006514 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6515 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6516
6517 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6518 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6519 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6520
6521 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006522 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006523 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6524 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6525 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6526 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6527 *Storage++ = D;
6528 }
6529
6530 return TemplateName(OT);
6531}
6532
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006533/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6534/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006535TemplateName
6536ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6537 bool TemplateKeyword,
6538 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006539 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6540
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006541 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006542 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6543 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6544
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006545 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006546 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6547 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6548 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006549 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6550 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006551 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6552 }
6553
6554 return TemplateName(QTN);
6555}
6556
6557/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6558/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006559TemplateName
6560ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6561 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006562 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006563 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006564
6565 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6566 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6567
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006568 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006569 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6570 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6571
6572 if (QTN)
6573 return TemplateName(QTN);
6574
6575 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6576 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006577 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6578 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006579 } else {
6580 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006581 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6582 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006583 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6584 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6585 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6586 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006587 }
6588
6589 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6590 return TemplateName(QTN);
6591}
6592
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006593/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6594/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6595TemplateName
6596ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006597 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006598 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6599 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6600
6601 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6602 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006603
6604 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006605 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6606 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006607
6608 if (QTN)
6609 return TemplateName(QTN);
6610
6611 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6612 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006613 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6614 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006615 } else {
6616 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006617 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6618 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006619
6620 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6621 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6622 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6623 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006624 }
6625
6626 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6627 return TemplateName(QTN);
6628}
6629
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006630TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006631ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6632 TemplateName replacement) const {
6633 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6634 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006635
6636 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006637 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6638 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6639
6640 if (!subst) {
6641 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6642 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6643 }
6644
6645 return TemplateName(subst);
6646}
6647
6648TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006649ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6650 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6651 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6652 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6653 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006654
6655 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006656 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6657 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6658
6659 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006660 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006661 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6662 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6663 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6664 }
6665
6666 return TemplateName(Subst);
6667}
6668
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006669/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006670/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6671/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006672CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006673 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006674 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00006675 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6676 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006677 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6678 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6679 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6680 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6681 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6682 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6683 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6684 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6685 }
6686
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006687 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006688}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006689
6690//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6691// Type Predicates.
6692//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6693
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006694/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6695/// garbage collection attribute.
6696///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006697Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006698 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006699 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6700
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006701 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006702 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6703
6704 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6705 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6706 // as __strong.
6707 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6708 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6709 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6710 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6711 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6712 } else {
6713 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6714 // pointer.
6715#ifndef NDEBUG
6716 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6717 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6718 CT = AT->getElementType();
6719 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6720#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006721 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006722 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006723}
6724
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006725//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6726// Type Compatibility Testing
6727//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006728
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006729/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006730/// compatible.
6731static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6732 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006733 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006734 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006735 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006736}
6737
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006738bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6739 QualType SecondVec) {
6740 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6741 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6742
6743 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6744 return true;
6745
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006746 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6747 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006748 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6749 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006750 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006751 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006752 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6753 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6754 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6755 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006756 return true;
6757
6758 return false;
6759}
6760
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006761//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6762// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6763//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6764
6765/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6766/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006767bool
6768ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6769 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006770 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006771 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00006772 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
6773 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006774 return true;
6775 return false;
6776}
6777
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006778/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6779/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006780bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6781 QualType rhs) {
6782 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6783 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6784 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6785
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006786 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006787 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006788 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006789 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6790 match = true;
6791 break;
6792 }
6793 }
6794 if (!match)
6795 return false;
6796 }
6797 return true;
6798}
6799
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006800/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6801/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6802bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6803 bool compare) {
6804 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006805 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006806 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6807 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006808 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006809 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6810 return true;
6811
6812 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006813 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006814
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006815 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006816
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006817 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006818 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006819 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6820 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006821 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006822 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6823 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6824 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006825 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006826 return false;
6827 }
6828 }
6829 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6830 return true;
6831 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006832 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006833 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006834 bool match = false;
6835
6836 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6837 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6838 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006839 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006840 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6841 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6842 match = true;
6843 break;
6844 }
6845 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006846 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006847 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6848 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006849 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006850 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6851 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6852 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006853 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006854 match = true;
6855 break;
6856 }
6857 }
6858 }
6859 if (!match)
6860 return false;
6861 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006862
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006863 return true;
6864 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006865
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006866 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6867 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6868
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006869 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006870 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006871 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006872 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006873 bool match = false;
6874
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006875 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006876 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6877 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006878 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6879 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006880 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006881 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6882 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6883 match = true;
6884 break;
6885 }
6886 }
6887 if (!match)
6888 return false;
6889 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006890
6891 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6892 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6893 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6894 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6895 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6896 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6897 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6898 // assume that it is mismatch.
6899 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6900 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006901 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006902 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006903 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006904 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6905 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6906 match = true;
6907 break;
6908 }
6909 }
6910 if (!match)
6911 return false;
6912 }
6913 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006914 return true;
6915 }
6916 return false;
6917}
6918
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006919/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006920/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6921/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6922///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006923bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6924 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006925 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6926 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6927
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006928 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006929 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6930 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006931 return true;
6932
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006933 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
6934 // __kindof types.
6935 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
6936 if (succeeded)
6937 return true;
6938
6939 if (!RHS->isKindOfType())
6940 return false;
6941
6942 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
6943 // we can assign the other way.
6944 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6945 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this));
6946 };
6947
6948 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) {
6949 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6950 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6951 false));
6952 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006953
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006954 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) {
6955 return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6956 QualType(RHSOPT,0)));
6957 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006958
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006959 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006960 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) {
6961 return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS));
6962 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006963
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006964 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006965}
6966
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006967/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006968/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006969/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6970/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6971/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6972bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6973 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006974 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6975 bool BlockReturnType) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006976
6977 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
6978 // __kindof types.
6979 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
6980 if (succeeded)
6981 return true;
6982
6983 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT;
6984 if (!Expected->isKindOfType())
6985 return false;
6986
6987 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
6988 // we can assign the other way.
6989 return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6990 RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6991 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6992 BlockReturnType);
6993 };
6994
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006995 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006996 return true;
6997
6998 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006999 return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ||
7000 RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType());
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007001 }
7002
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007003 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007004 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7005 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
7006 false));
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007007
7008 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7009 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7010 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
7011 if (LHS != RHS) {
7012 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007013 return finish(BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007014 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007015 return finish(!BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007016 }
7017 else
7018 return true;
7019 }
7020 return false;
7021}
7022
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007023/// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with
7024/// llvm::array_pod_sort.
7025static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs,
7026 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) {
7027 return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName());
7028
7029}
7030
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007031/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007032/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with
7033/// the given common base.
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007034/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
7035/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
7036static
7037void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007038 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase,
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007039 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
7040 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007041 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007042
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007043 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
7044 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
7045 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
7046 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007047
7048 // Add all of the protocols for the LHS.
7049 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet;
7050
7051 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7052 for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) {
7053 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007054 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007055
7056 // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface.
7057 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet);
7058
7059 // Add all of the protocls for the RHS.
7060 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet;
7061
7062 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7063 for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) {
7064 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007065 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007066
7067 // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface.
7068 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet);
7069
7070 // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets.
7071 for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) {
7072 if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto))
7073 IntersectionSet.push_back(proto);
7074 }
7075
7076 // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or
7077 // the protocols within the intersection.
7078 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols;
7079 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols);
7080
7081 // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols.
7082 if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) {
7083 IntersectionSet.erase(
7084 std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(),
7085 IntersectionSet.end(),
7086 [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool {
7087 return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0;
7088 }),
7089 IntersectionSet.end());
7090 }
7091
7092 // Sort the remaining protocols by name.
7093 llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(),
7094 compareObjCProtocolsByName);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007095}
7096
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007097/// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second.
7098static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs,
7099 QualType rhs) {
7100 // Common case: two object pointers.
7101 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7102 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7103 if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT)
7104 return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT);
7105
7106 // Two block pointers.
7107 const BlockPointerType *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7108 const BlockPointerType *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7109 if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock)
7110 return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs);
7111
7112 // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's
7113 // acceptable.
7114 if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) ||
7115 (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock))
7116 return true;
7117
7118 return false;
7119}
7120
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007121// Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007122static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx,
7123 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface,
7124 ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007125 ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,
7126 bool stripKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007127 if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size())
7128 return false;
7129
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007130 ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007131 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007132 if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7133 continue;
7134
7135 switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) {
7136 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant:
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007137 if (!stripKindOf ||
7138 !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx),
7139 rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) {
7140 return false;
7141 }
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007142 break;
7143
7144 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant:
7145 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7146 return false;
7147 break;
7148
7149 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant:
7150 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i]))
7151 return false;
7152 break;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007153 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007154 }
7155
7156 return true;
7157}
7158
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007159QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007160 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
7161 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007162 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
7163 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
7164 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
7165 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007166
7167 if (!LDecl || !RDecl)
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007168 return QualType();
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007169
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007170 // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a
7171 // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it.
7172 llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4>
7173 LHSAncestors;
7174 while (true) {
7175 // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the
7176 // path from the LHS to the root.
7177 LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007178
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007179 if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) {
7180 // Get the type arguments.
7181 ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7182 bool anyChanges = false;
7183 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7184 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007185 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7186 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007187 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007188 return QualType();
7189 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7190 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7191 // arguments.
7192 LHSTypeArgs = { };
7193 anyChanges = true;
7194 }
7195
7196 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007197 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007198 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7199 Protocols);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007200 if (!Protocols.empty())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007201 anyChanges = true;
7202
7203 // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type.
7204 if (anyChanges) {
7205 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007206 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
7207 LHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007208 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7209 }
7210
7211 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007212 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007213
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007214 // Find the superclass.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007215 QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType();
7216 if (LHSSuperType.isNull())
7217 break;
7218
7219 LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7220 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007221
7222 // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check
7223 // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors.
7224 while (true) {
7225 auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl());
7226 if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) {
7227 LHS = KnownLHS->second;
7228
7229 // Get the type arguments.
7230 ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7231 bool anyChanges = false;
7232 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7233 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007234 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7235 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007236 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007237 return QualType();
7238 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7239 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7240 // arguments.
7241 RHSTypeArgs = { };
7242 anyChanges = true;
7243 }
7244
7245 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
7246 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
7247 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7248 Protocols);
7249 if (!Protocols.empty())
7250 anyChanges = true;
7251
7252 if (anyChanges) {
7253 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007254 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
7255 RHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007256 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7257 }
7258
7259 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0));
7260 }
7261
7262 // Find the superclass of the RHS.
7263 QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType();
7264 if (RHSSuperType.isNull())
7265 break;
7266
7267 RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7268 }
7269
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007270 return QualType();
7271}
7272
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007273bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
7274 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
7275 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
7276 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
7277
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007278 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
7279 // the LHS.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007280 ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface();
7281 bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
7282 if (!IsSuperClass)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007283 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007284
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007285 // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are
7286 // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the
7287 // LHS).
7288 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) {
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007289 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
7290 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
7291 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
7292 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
7293 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
7294 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
7295 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
7296 // qualifiers.
7297 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007298 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007299 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
7300 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00007301 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007302
7303 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
7304 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
7305 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
7306 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
7307 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
7308 break;
7309 }
7310 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
7311 return false;
7312 }
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007313 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007314
7315 // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments.
7316 if (LHS->isSpecialized()) {
7317 // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the
7318 // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through.
7319 const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS;
7320 while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface))
7321 RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7322
7323 // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments.
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007324 if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() &&
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007325 !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7326 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007327 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007328 return false;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007329 }
7330 }
7331
7332 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007333}
7334
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007335bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7336 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007337 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7338 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007339
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007340 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007341 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007342
7343 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
7344 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007345}
7346
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00007347bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
7348 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
7349 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7350 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
7351}
7352
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007353/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007354/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007355/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007356/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007357bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
7358 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007359 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007360 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
7361
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007362 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007363}
7364
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00007365bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00007366 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00007367}
7368
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007369bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7370 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
7371}
7372
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007373/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
7374/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
7375/// QualType()
7376QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
7377 bool OfBlockPointer,
7378 bool Unqualified) {
7379 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
7380 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
7381 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00007382 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
7383 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007384 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7385 if (!MT.isNull())
7386 return MT;
7387 }
7388 }
7389 }
7390
7391 return QualType();
7392}
7393
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007394/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
7395/// parameter types
7396QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7397 bool OfBlockPointer,
7398 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007399 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
7400 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
7401 // type is compatible with a union member
7402 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
7403 Unqualified);
7404 if (!lmerge.isNull())
7405 return lmerge;
7406
7407 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
7408 Unqualified);
7409 if (!rmerge.isNull())
7410 return rmerge;
7411
7412 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7413}
7414
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007415QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007416 bool OfBlockPointer,
7417 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007418 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
7419 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007420 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
7421 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007422 bool allLTypes = true;
7423 bool allRTypes = true;
7424
7425 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007426 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007427 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007428 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
7429 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007430 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
7431 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
7432 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007433 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007434 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007435 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007436 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007437 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007438 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007439
7440 if (Unqualified)
7441 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
7442
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007443 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
7444 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007445 if (Unqualified) {
7446 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7447 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7448 }
7449
7450 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007451 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007452 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007453 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007454
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00007455 // FIXME: double check this
7456 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7457 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7458 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00007459 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
7460 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007461
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007462 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007463 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007464 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007465
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007466 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00007467 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
7468 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007469 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
7470 return QualType();
7471
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007472 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
7473 return QualType();
7474
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007475 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
7476 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007477
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00007478 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7479 allLTypes = false;
7480 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7481 allRTypes = false;
7482
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007483 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007484
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007485 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007486 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
7487 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007488 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
7489 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007490 return QualType();
7491
7492 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
7493 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
7494 return QualType();
7495
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00007496 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
7497 return QualType();
7498
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00007499 if (!doFunctionTypesMatchOnExtParameterInfos(rproto, lproto))
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007500 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007501
7502 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007503 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007504 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
7505 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7506 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7507 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
7508 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7509 if (paramType.isNull())
7510 return QualType();
7511
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007512 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007513 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
7514
7515 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007516 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007517 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7518 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007519 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007520
7521 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007522 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007523 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007524 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007525 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007526
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007527 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7528 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007529
7530 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
7531 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007532 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007533 }
7534
7535 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
7536 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
7537
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007538 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007539 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007540 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007541 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7542 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7543 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7544 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7545 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7546 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007547 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
7548 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007549
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007550 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007551 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007552 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7553 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7554 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007555 return QualType();
7556 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007557
7558 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7559 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007560 return QualType();
7561 }
7562
7563 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7564 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007565
7566 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7567 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007568 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007569 }
7570
7571 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7572 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007573 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007574}
7575
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007576/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7577static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7578 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7579 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7580 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7581 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7582 // type.
7583 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7584 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7585 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7586 return other;
7587
7588 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7589 // integral type of the same size.
7590 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7591 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7592 return other;
7593
7594 return QualType();
7595}
7596
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007597QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007598 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007599 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007600 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7601 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7602 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007603 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7604 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007605 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7606 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007607
7608 if (Unqualified) {
7609 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7610 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7611 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007612
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007613 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7614 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7615
7616 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7617 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7618 return LHS;
7619
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007620 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007621 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7622 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007623 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7624 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7625 // mismatch.
7626 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007627 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7628 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007629 return QualType();
7630
7631 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7632 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7633 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7634 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7635 // qualified __strong.
7636 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7637 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7638 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7639
7640 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7641 return QualType();
7642
7643 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7644 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7645 }
7646 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7647 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7648 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007649 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007650 }
7651
7652 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007653
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007654 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7655 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007656
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007657 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7658 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7659 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7660 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007661
7662 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007663 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7664 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7665 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7666 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007667
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007668 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7669 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7670 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7671
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007672 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7673 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7674 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007675
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007676 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007677 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007678 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7679 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007680 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007681 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007682 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007683 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007684 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007685 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007686 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007687 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7688 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7689 return LHS;
7690 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7691 return RHS;
7692 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007693
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007694 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007695 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007696
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007697 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007698 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007699#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7700#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007701#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007702#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7703#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7704#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007705 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007706
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007707 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007708 case Type::LValueReference:
7709 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007710 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007711 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007712
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007713 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007714 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7715 case Type::VariableArray:
7716 case Type::FunctionProto:
7717 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007718 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007719
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007720 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007721 {
7722 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007723 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7724 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007725 if (Unqualified) {
7726 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7727 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7728 }
7729 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7730 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007731 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007732 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007733 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007734 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007735 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007736 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7737 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007738 case Type::BlockPointer:
7739 {
7740 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007741 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7742 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007743 if (Unqualified) {
7744 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7745 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7746 }
7747 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7748 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007749 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7750 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7751 return LHS;
7752 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7753 return RHS;
7754 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7755 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007756 case Type::Atomic:
7757 {
7758 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7759 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7760 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7761 if (Unqualified) {
7762 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7763 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7764 }
7765 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7766 Unqualified);
7767 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7768 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7769 return LHS;
7770 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7771 return RHS;
7772 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7773 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007774 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007775 {
7776 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7777 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7778 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7779 return QualType();
7780
7781 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7782 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007783 if (Unqualified) {
7784 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7785 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7786 }
7787
7788 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007789 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007790 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7791 return LHS;
7792 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7793 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007794 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7795 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7796 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7797 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007798 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7799 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007800 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7801 return LHS;
7802 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7803 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007804 if (LVAT) {
7805 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7806 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7807 // has to be different.
7808 return LHS;
7809 }
7810 if (RVAT) {
7811 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7812 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7813 // has to be different.
7814 return RHS;
7815 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007816 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7817 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007818 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7819 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007820 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007821 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007822 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007823 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007824 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007825 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007826 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007827 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007828 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007829 case Type::Complex:
7830 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7831 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007832 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007833 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007834 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7835 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007836 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007837 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007838 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7839 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007840 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7841 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007842 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7843 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7844 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007845 return LHS;
7846
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007847 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007848 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007849 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007850 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7851 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7852 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007853 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7854 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007855 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007856 return QualType();
7857 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007858 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7859 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007860 return LHS;
7861
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007862 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007863 }
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00007864 case Type::Pipe:
7865 {
7866 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7867 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<PipeType>()->getElementType();
7868 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<PipeType>()->getElementType();
7869 if (Unqualified) {
7870 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7871 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7872 }
7873 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7874 Unqualified);
7875 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7876 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7877 return LHS;
7878 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7879 return RHS;
7880 return getPipeType(ResultType);
7881 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007882 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007883
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007884 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007885}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007886
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00007887bool ASTContext::doFunctionTypesMatchOnExtParameterInfos(
7888 const FunctionProtoType *firstFnType,
7889 const FunctionProtoType *secondFnType) {
7890 // Fast path: if the first type doesn't have ext parameter infos,
7891 // we match if and only if they second type also doesn't have them.
7892 if (!firstFnType->hasExtParameterInfos())
7893 return !secondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
7894
7895 // Otherwise, we can only match if the second type has them.
7896 if (!secondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos())
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007897 return false;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00007898
7899 auto firstEPI = firstFnType->getExtParameterInfos();
7900 auto secondEPI = secondFnType->getExtParameterInfos();
7901 assert(firstEPI.size() == secondEPI.size());
7902
7903 for (size_t i = 0, n = firstEPI.size(); i != n; ++i) {
7904 if (firstEPI[i] != secondEPI[i])
7905 return false;
7906 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007907 return true;
7908}
7909
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00007910void ASTContext::ResetObjCLayout(const ObjCContainerDecl *CD) {
7911 ObjCLayouts[CD] = nullptr;
7912}
7913
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007914/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7915/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7916/// return types.
7917QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7918 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7919 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7920 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7921 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7922 return LHS;
7923 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7924 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7925 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007926 QualType OldReturnType =
7927 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007928 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007929 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007930 QualType ResReturnType =
7931 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7932 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7933 return QualType();
7934 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7935 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7936 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7937 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7938 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007939 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7940 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007941 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007942 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007943 return ResultType;
7944 }
7945 }
7946 return QualType();
7947 }
7948
7949 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7950 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7951 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7952 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7953 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7954 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7955 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7956 return QualType();
7957
7958 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7959 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7960 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7961 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7962 // qualified __strong.
7963 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7964 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7965 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7966
7967 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7968 return QualType();
7969
7970 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7971 return LHS;
7972 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7973 return RHS;
7974 return QualType();
7975 }
7976
7977 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7978 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7979 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7980 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7981 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7982 return LHS;
7983 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7984 return RHS;
7985 }
7986 return QualType();
7987}
7988
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00007989//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007990// Integer Predicates
7991//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00007992
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007993unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00007994 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00007995 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00007996 if (T->isBooleanType())
7997 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00007998 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007999 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
8000}
8001
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00008002QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00008003 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008004
8005 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
8006 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
8007 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00008008 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008009
8010 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
8011 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008012 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008013
8014 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8015 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008016 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
8017 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
8018 case BuiltinType::SChar:
8019 return UnsignedCharTy;
8020 case BuiltinType::Short:
8021 return UnsignedShortTy;
8022 case BuiltinType::Int:
8023 return UnsignedIntTy;
8024 case BuiltinType::Long:
8025 return UnsignedLongTy;
8026 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
8027 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00008028 case BuiltinType::Int128:
8029 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008030 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008031 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008032 }
8033}
8034
Angel Garcia Gomez637d1e62015-10-20 13:23:58 +00008035ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00008036
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00008037void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
8038 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008039
8040//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8041// Builtin Type Computation
8042//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8043
8044/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008045/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
8046/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
8047/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
8048/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008049///
8050/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
8051/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008052static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008053 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008054 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008055 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008056 // Modifiers.
8057 int HowLong = 0;
8058 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008059 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008060
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008061 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008062 bool Done = false;
8063 while (!Done) {
8064 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008065 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008066 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008067 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008068 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008069 case 'S':
8070 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
8071 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
8072 Signed = true;
8073 break;
8074 case 'U':
8075 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008076 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008077 Unsigned = true;
8078 break;
8079 case 'L':
8080 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
8081 ++HowLong;
8082 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008083 case 'W':
8084 // This modifier represents int64 type.
8085 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
8086 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
8087 default:
8088 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
8089 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
8090 HowLong = 1;
8091 break;
8092 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
8093 HowLong = 2;
8094 break;
8095 }
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008096 }
8097 }
8098
8099 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008100
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008101 // Read the base type.
8102 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008103 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008104 case 'v':
8105 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8106 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
8107 Type = Context.VoidTy;
8108 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008109 case 'h':
8110 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008111 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008112 Type = Context.HalfTy;
8113 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008114 case 'f':
8115 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8116 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
8117 Type = Context.FloatTy;
8118 break;
8119 case 'd':
8120 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8121 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
8122 if (HowLong)
8123 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
8124 else
8125 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
8126 break;
8127 case 's':
8128 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
8129 if (Unsigned)
8130 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
8131 else
8132 Type = Context.ShortTy;
8133 break;
8134 case 'i':
8135 if (HowLong == 3)
8136 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
8137 else if (HowLong == 2)
8138 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
8139 else if (HowLong == 1)
8140 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
8141 else
8142 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
8143 break;
8144 case 'c':
8145 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
8146 if (Signed)
8147 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
8148 else if (Unsigned)
8149 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
8150 else
8151 Type = Context.CharTy;
8152 break;
8153 case 'b': // boolean
8154 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
8155 Type = Context.BoolTy;
8156 break;
8157 case 'z': // size_t.
8158 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
8159 Type = Context.getSizeType();
8160 break;
8161 case 'F':
8162 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
8163 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00008164 case 'G':
8165 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
8166 break;
8167 case 'H':
8168 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
8169 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00008170 case 'M':
8171 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
8172 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008173 case 'a':
8174 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8175 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
8176 break;
8177 case 'A':
8178 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
8179 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
8180 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
8181 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
8182 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
8183 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
8184 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
8185 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
8186 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8187 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008188 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008189 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008190 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008191 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008192 break;
8193 case 'V': {
8194 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008195 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8196 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008197 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008198
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008199 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
8200 RequiresICE, false);
8201 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008202
8203 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00008204 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00008205 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008206 break;
8207 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00008208 case 'E': {
8209 char *End;
8210
8211 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8212 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
8213
8214 Str = End;
8215
8216 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8217 false);
8218 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
8219 break;
8220 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00008221 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008222 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8223 false);
8224 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00008225 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
8226 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00008227 }
8228 case 'Y' : {
8229 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
8230 break;
8231 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00008232 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00008233 Type = Context.getFILEType();
8234 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008235 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008236 return QualType();
8237 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008238 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00008239 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008240 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00008241 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008242 else
8243 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
8244
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008245 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008246 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008247 return QualType();
8248 }
8249 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00008250 case 'K':
8251 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
8252 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
8253
8254 if (Type.isNull()) {
8255 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
8256 return QualType();
8257 }
8258 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00008259 case 'p':
8260 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
8261 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00008262 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008263
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008264 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
8265 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008266 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00008267 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008268 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
8269 case '*':
8270 case '&': {
8271 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
8272 // qualified with an address space.
8273 char *End;
8274 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8275 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
8276 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
8277 Str = End;
8278 }
8279 if (c == '*')
8280 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
8281 else
8282 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
8283 break;
8284 }
8285 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
8286 case 'C':
8287 Type = Type.withConst();
8288 break;
8289 case 'D':
8290 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
8291 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00008292 case 'R':
8293 Type = Type.withRestrict();
8294 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008295 }
8296 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008297
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008298 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008299 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008300
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008301 return Type;
8302}
8303
8304/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008305QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008306 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008307 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Eric Christopher02d5d862015-08-06 01:01:12 +00008308 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008309
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008310 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008311
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008312 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008313 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008314 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
8315 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008316 if (Error != GE_None)
8317 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008318
8319 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
8320
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008321 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008322 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008323 if (Error != GE_None)
8324 return QualType();
8325
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008326 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
8327 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
8328 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
8329 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
8330
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008331 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
8332 if (Ty->isArrayType())
8333 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008334
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008335 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
8336 }
8337
David Majnemerba3e5ec2015-03-13 18:26:17 +00008338 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
8339 return QualType();
8340
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008341 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
8342 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
8343
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008344 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00008345 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
8346
8347 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
8348
8349 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
8350 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
8351 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00008352
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008353 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00008354 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
8355 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008356
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00008357 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008358}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00008359
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008360static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
8361 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008362 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008363 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008364
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008365 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8366 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
8367 case TSK_Undeclared:
8368 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
8369 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8370 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008371
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008372 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008373 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008374
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00008375 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
8376 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
8377 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
8378 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
8379 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
8380 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008381 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008382 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8383
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008384 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008385 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008386 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008387 }
8388
8389 if (!FD->isInlined())
8390 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00008391
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00008392 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
8393 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008394 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00008395 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008396 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
8397
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008398 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
8399 // externally visible.
8400 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
8401 return External;
8402
8403 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008404 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008405 }
8406
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008407 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
8408 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
8409 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
David Majnemer73768702015-03-20 00:02:27 +00008410 if (FD->isMSExternInline())
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008411 return GVA_StrongODR;
8412
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008413 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008414}
8415
Artem Belevich7b41f702015-09-23 17:44:53 +00008416static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008417 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
8418 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
8419 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
8420 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
8421 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Artem Belevich7b41f702015-09-23 17:44:53 +00008422 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() || D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008423 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
8424 return GVA_StrongODR;
8425 }
8426 return L;
8427}
8428
8429GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
Artem Belevich7b41f702015-09-23 17:44:53 +00008430 return adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD),
8431 FD);
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008432}
8433
8434static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
8435 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008436 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
8437 return GVA_Internal;
8438
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008439 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
8440 GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
8441 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
8442 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
8443 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
8444
Richard Smith9e2341d2015-03-23 03:25:59 +00008445 // Let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the nearest
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008446 // enclosing function.
8447 if (LexicalContext)
8448 StaticLocalLinkage =
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008449 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008450
8451 // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
8452 // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
8453 // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
8454 return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
8455 : StaticLocalLinkage;
8456 }
8457
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00008458 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
8459 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
8460 // cause link errors.
8461 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
8462 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8463
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00008464 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008465 case TSK_Undeclared:
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008466 return GVA_StrongExternal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008467
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008468 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00008469 return Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
8470 VD->isStaticDataMember()
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008471 ? GVA_StrongODR
8472 : GVA_StrongExternal;
8473
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008474 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008475 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008476
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008477 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
8478 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8479
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008480 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008481 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008482 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00008483
8484 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008485}
8486
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008487GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
Artem Belevich7b41f702015-09-23 17:44:53 +00008488 return adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD),
8489 VD);
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008490}
8491
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00008492bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008493 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
8494 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
8495 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00008496 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
8497 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
8498 return false;
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00008499 if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
8500 isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
8501 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00008502 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8503 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
8504 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
8505 return false;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00008506 } else if (isa<PragmaCommentDecl>(D))
8507 return true;
Nico Webercbbaeb12016-03-02 19:28:54 +00008508 else if (isa<PragmaDetectMismatchDecl>(D))
8509 return true;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00008510 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
Alexey Bataevc5b1d322016-03-04 09:22:22 +00008511 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
8512 else if (isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(D))
8513 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
Alexey Bataev97720002014-11-11 04:05:39 +00008514 else
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00008515 return false;
8516
8517 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
8518 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008519 return false;
8520
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00008521 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
8522 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
8523 return false;
8524
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008525 // Aliases and used decls are required.
8526 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
8527 return true;
8528
8529 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8530 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00008531 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00008532 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008533
8534 // Constructors and destructors are required.
8535 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
8536 return true;
8537
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00008538 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
8539 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
8540 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
8541 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
8542 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
8543 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
8544 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
8545 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
8546 return true;
8547 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008548 }
8549 }
8550
8551 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
8552
8553 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
8554 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
8555 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008556 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally ||
8557 Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR)
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008558 return false;
8559 return true;
8560 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00008561
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008562 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
8563 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
8564
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00008565 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
8566 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00008567 return false;
8568
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008569 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008570 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00008571 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally &&
8572 L != GVA_DiscardableODR)
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008573 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008574
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008575 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
8576 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
8577 return true;
8578
8579 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00008580 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) &&
8581 !VD->evaluateValue())
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008582 return true;
8583
8584 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008585}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00008586
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008587CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
8588 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008589 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008590 if (IsCXXMethod)
8591 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00008592
Alexander Kornienko21de0ae2015-01-20 11:20:41 +00008593 if (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) return CC_X86StdCall;
8594
8595 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown);
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008596}
8597
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008598bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00008599 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
8600 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
8601}
8602
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00008603VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
8604 if (!VTContext.get()) {
8605 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
8606 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
8607 else
8608 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
8609 }
8610 return VTContext.get();
8611}
8612
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008613MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008614 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00008615 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008616 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
8617 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +00008618 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008619 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00008620 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +00008621 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +00008622 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008623 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008624 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008625 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008626 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008627 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008628}
8629
Angel Garcia Gomez637d1e62015-10-20 13:23:58 +00008630CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008631
8632size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00008633 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
8634 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
8635 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
8636 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8637 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8638 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8639 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8640 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8641 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8642 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8643 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8644 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8645 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8646 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008647}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008648
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00008649/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8650/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8651/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8652/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8653QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8654 unsigned Signed) const {
8655 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8656 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8657 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8658 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8659 return QualTy;
8660}
8661
8662/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8663/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8664/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8665QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8666 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8667 switch (Ty) {
8668 case TargetInfo::Float:
8669 return FloatTy;
8670 case TargetInfo::Double:
8671 return DoubleTy;
8672 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8673 return LongDoubleTy;
8674 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8675 return QualType();
8676 }
8677
8678 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8679}
8680
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008681void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8682 if (Number > 1)
8683 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008684}
8685
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008686unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8687 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8688 MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8689 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008690}
8691
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00008692void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8693 if (Number > 1)
8694 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8695}
8696
8697unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8698 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8699 StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
8700 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8701}
8702
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008703MangleNumberingContext &
8704ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00008705 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8706 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8707 if (!MCtx)
8708 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8709 return *MCtx;
8710}
8711
8712MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8713 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008714}
8715
David Majnemere7a818f2015-03-06 18:53:55 +00008716const CXXConstructorDecl *
8717ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
8718 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8719 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
8720}
8721
8722void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
8723 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
8724 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8725 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
8726 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
8727}
8728
David Majnemerdfa6d202015-03-11 18:36:39 +00008729void ASTContext::addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8730 unsigned ParmIdx, Expr *DAE) {
8731 ABI->addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8732 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx, DAE);
8733}
8734
8735Expr *ASTContext::getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8736 unsigned ParmIdx) {
8737 return ABI->getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8738 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx);
8739}
8740
David Majnemer00350522015-08-31 18:48:39 +00008741void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
8742 TypedefNameDecl *DD) {
8743 return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
8744}
8745
8746TypedefNameDecl *
8747ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
8748 return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
8749}
8750
8751void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
8752 DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
8753 return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
8754}
8755
8756DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
8757 return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
8758}
8759
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008760void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8761 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8762}
8763
8764unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8765 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8766 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8767 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8768 return I->second;
8769}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008770
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008771APValue *
8772ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8773 bool MayCreate) {
8774 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8775 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00008776 if (MayCreate) {
8777 APValue *&MTVI = MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8778 if (!MTVI)
8779 MTVI = new (*this) APValue;
8780 return MTVI;
8781 }
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008782
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00008783 return MaterializedTemporaryValues.lookup(E);
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008784}
8785
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008786bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8787 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8788 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8789 return false;
8790
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00008791 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8792 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8793 return false;
8794
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008795 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8796 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8797 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8798 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8799 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8800 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8801 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8802}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008803
8804namespace {
8805
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008806ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(
8807 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers::mapped_type U) {
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00008808 if (const auto *D = U.dyn_cast<const Decl *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008809 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*D);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00008810 if (const auto *S = U.dyn_cast<const Stmt *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008811 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*S);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00008812 return *U.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008813}
8814
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008815/// Template specializations to abstract away from pointers and TypeLocs.
8816/// @{
8817template <typename T>
8818ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const T &Node) {
8819 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node);
8820}
8821template <>
8822ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const TypeLoc &Node) {
8823 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
8824}
8825template <>
8826ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode
8827createDynTypedNode(const NestedNameSpecifierLoc &Node) {
8828 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
8829}
8830/// @}
8831
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008832 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8833 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8834 ///
8835 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8836 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8837 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8838 ///
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00008839 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008840 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008841 public:
8842 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8843 ///
8844 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008845 static std::pair<ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *,
8846 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *>
8847 buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8848 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMapPointers,
8849 new ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008850 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008851 return std::make_pair(Visitor.Parents, Visitor.OtherParents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008852 }
8853
8854 private:
8855 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8856
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008857 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents,
8858 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents)
8859 : Parents(Parents), OtherParents(OtherParents) {}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008860
8861 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8862 return true;
8863 }
8864 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8865 return true;
8866 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008867
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008868 template <typename T, typename MapNodeTy, typename BaseTraverseFn,
8869 typename MapTy>
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008870 bool TraverseNode(T Node, MapNodeTy MapNode,
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008871 BaseTraverseFn BaseTraverse, MapTy *Parents) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008872 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008873 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008874 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00008875 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
8876 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
8877 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
8878 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
8879 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
8880 // new matches.
8881 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8882 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8883 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8884 // do not have pointer identity.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008885 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[MapNode];
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008886 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008887 if (const auto *D = ParentStack.back().get<Decl>())
8888 NodeOrVector = D;
8889 else if (const auto *S = ParentStack.back().get<Stmt>())
8890 NodeOrVector = S;
8891 else
8892 NodeOrVector =
8893 new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008894 } else {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008895 if (!NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
8896 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(
8897 1, getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(NodeOrVector));
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008898 if (auto *Node =
8899 NodeOrVector
8900 .template dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>())
8901 delete Node;
Benjamin Kramer422b3ff2015-10-23 13:24:18 +00008902 NodeOrVector = Vector;
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008903 }
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008904
8905 auto *Vector =
8906 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
8907 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
8908 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
8909 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
8910 // types.
8911 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
8912 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
8913 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
8914 if (!Found)
8915 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008916 }
8917 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008918 ParentStack.push_back(createDynTypedNode(Node));
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008919 bool Result = BaseTraverse();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008920 ParentStack.pop_back();
8921 return Result;
8922 }
8923
8924 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008925 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, DeclNode,
8926 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseDecl(DeclNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008927 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008928 }
8929
8930 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008931 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, StmtNode,
8932 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseStmt(StmtNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008933 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008934 }
8935
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008936 bool TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLoc TypeLocNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008937 return TraverseNode(
8938 TypeLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(TypeLocNode),
8939 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLocNode); },
8940 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008941 }
8942
8943 bool TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLocNode) {
8944 return TraverseNode(
8945 NNSLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(NNSLocNode),
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008946 [&] {
8947 return VisitorBase::TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NNSLocNode);
8948 },
8949 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008950 }
8951
8952 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents;
8953 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008954 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8955
8956 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8957 };
8958
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00008959} // anonymous namespace
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008960
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008961template <typename NodeTy, typename MapTy>
8962static ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList getDynNodeFromMap(const NodeTy &Node,
8963 const MapTy &Map) {
8964 auto I = Map.find(Node);
8965 if (I == Map.end()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008966 return llvm::ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008967 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008968 if (auto *V = I->second.template dyn_cast<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008969 return llvm::makeArrayRef(*V);
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008970 }
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008971 return getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(I->second);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008972}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008973
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008974ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList
8975ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8976 if (!PointerParents) {
8977 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8978 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8979 auto Maps = ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl());
8980 PointerParents.reset(Maps.first);
8981 OtherParents.reset(Maps.second);
8982 }
8983 if (Node.getNodeKind().hasPointerIdentity())
8984 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node.getMemoizationData(), *PointerParents);
8985 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node, *OtherParents);
8986}
8987
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008988bool
8989ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8990 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8991 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8992 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8993 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8994 return false;
8995 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8996 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8997 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008998 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008999 return false;
9000
9001 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
9002 return false;
9003
9004 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
9005 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
9006 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
9007 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
9008 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
9009 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
9010 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9011 return false;
9012 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
9013 return false;
9014 }
9015 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
9016
9017}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00009018
9019// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
9020// doesn't include ASTContext.h
9021template
9022clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9023 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
9024clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9025 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
9026 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);